]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blame - gdb/doc/gdb.texinfo
Fix adr pseudo op for Thumb.
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c
SS
1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2@c Copyright 1988-1999
3@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4@c
5@c %**start of header
6@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
7@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
8@setfilename gdb.info
9@c
10@include gdb-cfg.texi
11@c
c906108c 12@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
13@setchapternewpage odd
14@c %**end of header
15
16@iftex
17@c @smallbook
18@c @cropmarks
19@end iftex
20
21@finalout
22@syncodeindex ky cp
23
24@c readline appendices use @vindex
25@syncodeindex vr cp
26
27@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
28@set EDITION Seventh
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
31@set DATE February 1999
32
33@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO-2 macros and info-makers to format properly.
34
35@ifinfo
36@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
37@c manuals to an info tree. zoo@cygnus.com is developing this facility.
38@format
39START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
40* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
41END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
42@end format
43@end ifinfo
44@c
45@c
46@ifinfo
47This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
51of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
52for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54Copyright (C) 1988-1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
55
56Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
57this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
58are preserved on all copies.
59
60@ignore
61Permission is granted to process this file through TeX and print the
62results, provided the printed document carries copying permission
63notice identical to this one except for the removal of this paragraph
64(this paragraph not being relevant to the printed manual).
65
66@end ignore
67Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
68manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
69entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
70permission notice identical to this one.
71
72Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
73into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
74@end ifinfo
75
76@titlepage
77@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
78@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 79@sp 1
c906108c
SS
80@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
81@subtitle @value{DATE}
82@author Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch
c906108c 83@page
c906108c
SS
84@tex
85{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 86\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
87\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
88\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
89}
90@end tex
53a5351d
JM
91
92@c ISBN seems to be wrong...
c906108c
SS
93
94@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
95Copyright @copyright{} 1988-1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
96@sp 2
c906108c
SS
97Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
9859 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
99Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
100Printed copies are available for $20 each. @*
101ISBN 1-882114-11-6 @*
c906108c
SS
102
103Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
104this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
105are preserved on all copies.
106
107Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
108manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
109entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
110permission notice identical to this one.
111
112Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
113into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
114@end titlepage
115@page
116
117@ifinfo
53a5351d 118@node Top
c906108c
SS
119@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
120
121This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
122
123This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
124@value{GDBVN}.
125
126Copyright (C) 1988-1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
127@menu
128* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
c906108c 129* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
c906108c
SS
130
131* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
132* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
133* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
134* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
135* Stack:: Examining the stack
136* Source:: Examining source files
137* Data:: Examining data
c906108c 138
7a292a7a 139* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
c906108c
SS
140
141* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
142* Altering:: Altering execution
143* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
144* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
104c1213 145* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
c906108c
SS
146* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
147* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c906108c 148* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d700128c 149* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotations interface.
c906108c
SS
150
151* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 152* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
c906108c
SS
153
154* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
155* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
156* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
157* Index:: Index
c906108c
SS
158@end menu
159
160@end ifinfo
161
53a5351d 162@node Summary
c906108c
SS
163@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
164
165The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
166going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
167program was doing at the moment it crashed.
168
169@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
170these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
171
172@itemize @bullet
173@item
174Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
175
176@item
177Make your program stop on specified conditions.
178
179@item
180Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
181
182@item
183Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
184effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
185@end itemize
186
cce74817 187You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 188For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
189For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
190
cce74817
JM
191@cindex Chill
192@cindex Modula-2
c906108c 193Support for Modula-2 and Chill is partial. For information on Modula-2,
cce74817 194see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
c906108c 195
cce74817
JM
196@cindex Pascal
197Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
198nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
199entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
200syntax.
c906108c 201
c906108c
SS
202@cindex Fortran
203@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 204it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 205underscore.
c906108c 206
c906108c
SS
207@menu
208* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
209* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
210@end menu
211
53a5351d 212@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
213@unnumberedsec Free software
214
215@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
216General Public License
217(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
218program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
219freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
220the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
221Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
222Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
223
224Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
225you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
226from anyone else.
227
53a5351d 228@node Contributors
c906108c
SS
229@unnumberedsec Contributors to GDB
230
231Richard Stallman was the original author of GDB, and of many other
232@sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its development.
233This section attempts to credit major contributors. One of the virtues
234of free software is that everyone is free to contribute to it; with
235regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The file
236@file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
237blow-by-blow account.
238
239Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
240
241@quotation
242@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
243or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
244omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
245@end quotation
246
247So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
248particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
249releases:
250Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
251Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
252Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
253Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
254Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
255John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
256Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
257and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
258
259Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
260Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
261
c906108c
SS
262Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C++ support in GDB,
263with significant additional contributions from Per Bothner. James
264Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C++ demangler. Early work on C++ was by Peter
265TerMaat (who also did much general update work leading to release 3.0).
c906108c
SS
266
267@value{GDBN} 4 uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
268object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
269Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
270
271David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
272the original support for encapsulated COFF.
273
274Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
275
276Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
277Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
278support.
279Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
280Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
281Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
282David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
283Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
284Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
285Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
286Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
287Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
288Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
289Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
290Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
291Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
292Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
293Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
294
295Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
296
297Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
298libraries.
299
300Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
301about several machine instruction sets.
302
303Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
304remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
305contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
306and RDI targets, respectively.
307
308Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
309command-line editing and command history.
310
7a292a7a
SS
311Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
312Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c
SS
313
314Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
c906108c
SS
315He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C++ overloaded
316symbols.
c906108c
SS
317
318Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
319Super-H processors.
320
321NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
322
323Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
324
325Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
326
327Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
328
329Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors
330
331Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
332watchpoints.
333
334Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
335
336Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
337
338Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
339nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout GDB.
340
341The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
342support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
343(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC++
344compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
345John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
346Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
347information in this manual.
348
349Cygnus Solutions has sponsored GDB maintenance and much of its
350development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on GDB
2df3850c
JM
351fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
352Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
353Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
354Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
355Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
356addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
357JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
358Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
359Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
360Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
361Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
362Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
363Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c
SS
364
365
53a5351d 366@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
367@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
368
369You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
370However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
371debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
372
373@iftex
374In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
375to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
376@end iftex
377
378@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
379@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
380
381One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
382processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
383quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
384definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
385session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
386then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
387same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
388@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
389procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
390
391@smallexample
392$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
393$ @b{./m4}
394@b{define(foo,0000)}
395
396@b{foo}
3970000
398@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
399
400@b{bar}
4010000
402@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
403
404@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
405@b{baz}
406@b{C-d}
407m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
408@end smallexample
409
410@noindent
411Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
412
c906108c
SS
413@smallexample
414$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
415@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
416@c FIXME... format to come out better.
417@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
418 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
419 the conditions.
420There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
421 for details.
422
423@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
424(@value{GDBP})
425@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
426
427@noindent
428@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
429rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
430We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
431that examples fit in this manual.
432
433@smallexample
434(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
435@end smallexample
436
437@noindent
438We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
439Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
440@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
441@code{break} command.
442
443@smallexample
444(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
445Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
446@end smallexample
447
448@noindent
449Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
450control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
451subroutine, the program runs as usual:
452
453@smallexample
454(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
455Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
456@b{define(foo,0000)}
457
458@b{foo}
4590000
460@end smallexample
461
462@noindent
463To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
464suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
465context where it stops.
466
467@smallexample
468@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
469
470Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
471 at builtin.c:879
472879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
473@end smallexample
474
475@noindent
476Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
477the next line of the current function.
478
479@smallexample
480(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
481882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
482 : nil,
483@end smallexample
484
485@noindent
486@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
487by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
488@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
489subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
490
491@smallexample
492(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
493set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
494 at input.c:530
495530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
496@end smallexample
497
498@noindent
499The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
500suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
501shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
502command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
503in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
504stack frame for each active subroutine.
505
506@smallexample
507(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
508#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
509 at input.c:530
510#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
511 at builtin.c:882
512#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
513#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
514 at macro.c:71
515#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
516#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
517@end smallexample
518
519@noindent
520We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
521times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
522falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
523
524@smallexample
525(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5260x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
527(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5280x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
529def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
530(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
531536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
532 : xstrdup(rq);
533(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
534538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
535@end smallexample
536
537@noindent
538The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
539@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
540and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
541(@code{print}) to see their values.
542
543@smallexample
544(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
545$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
546(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
547$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
548@end smallexample
549
550@noindent
551@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
552To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
553surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
554
555@smallexample
556(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
557533 xfree(rquote);
558534
559535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
560 : xstrdup (lq);
561536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
562 : xstrdup (rq);
563537
564538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
565539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
566540 @}
567541
568542 void
569@end smallexample
570
571@noindent
572Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
573@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
574
575@smallexample
576(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
577539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
578(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
579540 @}
580(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
581$3 = 9
582(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
583$4 = 7
584@end smallexample
585
586@noindent
587That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
588@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
589@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
590the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
591any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
592assignments.
593
594@smallexample
595(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
596$5 = 7
597(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
598$6 = 9
599@end smallexample
600
601@noindent
602Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
603@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
604executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
605example that caused trouble initially:
606
607@smallexample
608(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
609Continuing.
610
611@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
612
613baz
6140000
615@end smallexample
616
617@noindent
618Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
619problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
620lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
621
622@smallexample
623@b{C-d}
624Program exited normally.
625@end smallexample
626
627@noindent
628The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
629indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
630session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
631
632@smallexample
633(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
634@end smallexample
c906108c 635
53a5351d 636@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
637@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
638
639This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
640The essentials are:
641@itemize @bullet
642@item
53a5351d 643type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
644@item
645type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
646@end itemize
647
648@menu
649* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
650* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
651* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
652@end menu
653
53a5351d 654@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
655@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
656
c906108c
SS
657Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
658@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
659
660You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
661to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
662
c906108c
SS
663The command-line options described here are designed
664to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
665options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
666
667The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
668specifying an executable program:
669
670@example
671@value{GDBP} @var{program}
672@end example
673
c906108c
SS
674@noindent
675You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
676specified:
677
678@example
679@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
680@end example
681
682You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
683to debug a running process:
684
685@example
686@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
687@end example
688
689@noindent
690would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
691named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
692
c906108c 693Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
694complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
695debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
696``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
697will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c
SS
698
699You can run @code{gdb} without printing the front material, which describes
700@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
701
702@smallexample
703@value{GDBP} -silent
704@end smallexample
705
706@noindent
707You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
708options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
709
710@noindent
711Type
712
713@example
714@value{GDBP} -help
715@end example
716
717@noindent
718to display all available options and briefly describe their use
719(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
720
721All options and command line arguments you give are processed
722in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
723@samp{-x} option is used.
724
725
726@menu
c906108c
SS
727* File Options:: Choosing files
728* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
729@end menu
730
c906108c
SS
731@node File Options
732@subsection Choosing files
733
2df3850c 734When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
735specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
736the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
737@samp{-c} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the first argument
738that does not have an associated option flag as equivalent to the
739@samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the second argument
740that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as equivalent to
741the @samp{-c} option followed by that argument.)
7a292a7a
SS
742
743If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
744such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
745argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
746
747Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
748following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
749them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
750(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
751than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
752
d700128c
EZ
753@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
754@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
755@c it.
756
c906108c
SS
757@table @code
758@item -symbols @var{file}
759@itemx -s @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
760@cindex @code{--symbols}
761@cindex @code{-s}
c906108c
SS
762Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
763
764@item -exec @var{file}
765@itemx -e @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
766@cindex @code{--exec}
767@cindex @code{-e}
7a292a7a
SS
768Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
769and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
770
771@item -se @var{file}
d700128c 772@cindex @code{--se}
c906108c
SS
773Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
774file.
775
c906108c
SS
776@item -core @var{file}
777@itemx -c @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
778@cindex @code{--core}
779@cindex @code{-c}
c906108c
SS
780Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
781
782@item -c @var{number}
783Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command
784(unless there is a file in core-dump format named @var{number}, in which
785case @samp{-c} specifies that file as a core dump to read).
c906108c
SS
786
787@item -command @var{file}
788@itemx -x @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
789@cindex @code{--command}
790@cindex @code{-x}
c906108c
SS
791Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
792Files,, Command files}.
793
794@item -directory @var{directory}
795@itemx -d @var{directory}
d700128c
EZ
796@cindex @code{--directory}
797@cindex @code{-d}
c906108c
SS
798Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
799
c906108c
SS
800@item -m
801@itemx -mapped
d700128c
EZ
802@cindex @code{--mapped}
803@cindex @code{-m}
c906108c
SS
804@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
805supported on all systems.}@*
806If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
807system call, you can use this option
808to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
809program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
810called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{./fred.syms}.
811Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
812and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
813the symbol table from the executable program.
814
815The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
816is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
817table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 818
c906108c
SS
819@item -r
820@itemx -readnow
d700128c
EZ
821@cindex @code{--readnow}
822@cindex @code{-r}
c906108c
SS
823Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
824the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
825This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 826
c906108c
SS
827@end table
828
2df3850c 829You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 830order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
831information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
832on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
833but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c
SS
834
835@example
2df3850c 836gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
c906108c 837@end example
c906108c 838
53a5351d 839@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
840@subsection Choosing modes
841
842You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
843batch mode or quiet mode.
844
845@table @code
846@item -nx
847@itemx -n
d700128c
EZ
848@cindex @code{--nx}
849@cindex @code{-n}
2df3850c
JM
850Do not execute commands found in any initialization files (normally
851called @file{.gdbinit}, or @file{gdb.ini} on PCs). Normally,
852@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
853options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
854files}.
c906108c
SS
855
856@item -quiet
d700128c 857@itemx -silent
c906108c 858@itemx -q
d700128c
EZ
859@cindex @code{--quiet}
860@cindex @code{--silent}
861@cindex @code{-q}
c906108c
SS
862``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
863messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
864
865@item -batch
d700128c 866@cindex @code{--batch}
c906108c
SS
867Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
868command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
869initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
870nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
871in the command files.
872
2df3850c
JM
873Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
874example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
875make this more useful, the message
c906108c
SS
876
877@example
878Program exited normally.
879@end example
880
881@noindent
2df3850c
JM
882(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
883@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
884mode.
885
886@item -nowindows
887@itemx -nw
d700128c
EZ
888@cindex @code{--nowindows}
889@cindex @code{-nw}
2df3850c
JM
890``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
891(GUI) built in, then this option tells GDB to only use the command-line
892interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
893
894@item -windows
895@itemx -w
d700128c
EZ
896@cindex @code{--windows}
897@cindex @code{-w}
2df3850c
JM
898If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
899used if possible.
c906108c
SS
900
901@item -cd @var{directory}
d700128c 902@cindex @code{--cd}
c906108c
SS
903Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
904instead of the current directory.
905
c906108c
SS
906@item -fullname
907@itemx -f
d700128c
EZ
908@cindex @code{--fullname}
909@cindex @code{-f}
7a292a7a
SS
910@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
911subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
912number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
913displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
914recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
915the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
916and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
917@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
918frame.
c906108c 919
d700128c
EZ
920@item -epoch
921@cindex @code{--epoch}
922The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
923@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
924routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
925separate window.
926
927@item -annotate @var{level}
928@cindex @code{--annotate}
929This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
930effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
931(@pxref{Annotations}).
932Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
933together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
934types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
935@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
936maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
937
938@item -async
939@cindex @code{--async}
940Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
941@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
942special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
943commands in parallel with the debugged process being
944run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
945MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
946suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
947control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
948(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.0, the target side of the asynchronous
949operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
950yet.)
951@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
952@c should be removed.
953
954When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
955uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
956@samp{-noasync} option.
957
958@item -noasync
959@cindex @code{--noasync}
960Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
961
2df3850c
JM
962@item -baud @var{bps}
963@itemx -b @var{bps}
d700128c
EZ
964@cindex @code{--baud}
965@cindex @code{-b}
c906108c
SS
966Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
967interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
968
969@item -tty @var{device}
d700128c
EZ
970@itemx -t @var{device}
971@cindex @code{--tty}
972@cindex @code{-t}
c906108c
SS
973Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
974@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 975
53a5351d
JM
976@c resolve the situation of these eventually
977@c @item -tui
d700128c 978@c @cindex @code{--tui}
53a5351d
JM
979@c Use a Terminal User Interface. For information, use your Web browser to
980@c read the file @file{TUI.html}, which is usually installed in the
981@c directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX systems. Do not use
982@c this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (see @pxref{Emacs, ,Using
983@c @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
984
985@c @item -xdb
d700128c 986@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
53a5351d
JM
987@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
988@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
989@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
990@c systems.
991
d700128c
EZ
992@item -interpreter @var{interp}
993@cindex @code{--interpreter}
994Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
995program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
996communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end. For example,
997@samp{--interpreter=mi} causes @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{gdbmi
998interface}.
999@c FIXME: There should be an @xref here to the GDB/MI docs, but
1000@c gdbmi.texi doesn't have a single node to reference!
1001
1002@item -write
1003@cindex @code{--write}
1004Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1005is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1006(@pxref{Patching}).
1007
1008@item -statistics
1009@cindex @code{--statistics}
1010This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1011memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1012
1013@item -version
1014@cindex @code{--version}
1015This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1016no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1017
c906108c
SS
1018@end table
1019
53a5351d 1020@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
1021@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1022@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1023@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1024
1025@table @code
1026@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1027@kindex q
1028@item quit
1029To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated @code{q}), or
1030type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you do not supply
1031@var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally; otherwise it will
1032terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the error code.
1033@end table
1034
1035@cindex interrupt
1036An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1037terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1038returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1039character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1040until a time when it is safe.
1041
c906108c
SS
1042If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1043device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1044(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 1045
53a5351d 1046@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
1047@section Shell commands
1048
1049If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1050debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1051just use the @code{shell} command.
1052
1053@table @code
1054@kindex shell
1055@cindex shell escape
1056@item shell @var{command string}
1057Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 1058If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
1059shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1060(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
1061@end table
1062
1063The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1064You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1065@value{GDBN}:
1066
1067@table @code
1068@kindex make
1069@cindex calling make
1070@item make @var{make-args}
1071Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1072arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1073@end table
1074
53a5351d 1075@node Commands
c906108c
SS
1076@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1077
1078You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1079name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1080@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1081key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1082show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1083
1084@menu
1085* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1086* Completion:: Command completion
1087* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1088@end menu
1089
53a5351d 1090@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
1091@section Command syntax
1092
1093A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1094how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1095arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1096command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1097step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1098with no arguments. Some command names do not allow any arguments.
1099
1100@cindex abbreviation
1101@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1102unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1103documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1104abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1105equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1106names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1107arguments to the @code{help} command.
1108
1109@cindex repeating commands
1110@kindex RET
1111A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1112repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1113will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1114repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1115repeat.
1116
1117The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1118@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1119exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1120
1121@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1122output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1123(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1124@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1125repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1126
1127@kindex #
1128@cindex comment
1129Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1130nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1131Files,,Command files}).
1132
53a5351d 1133@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1134@section Command completion
1135
1136@cindex completion
1137@cindex word completion
1138@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1139only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1140are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1141commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1142
1143Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1144of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1145word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1146enter it). For example, if you type
1147
1148@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1149@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1150@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1151@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1152@example
1153(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1154@end example
1155
1156@noindent
1157@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1158the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1159
1160@example
1161(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1162@end example
1163
1164@noindent
1165You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1166breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1167@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1168were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1169might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1170to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1171
1172If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1173@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1174characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1175@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1176example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1177begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1178just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1179function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1180example:
1181
1182@example
1183(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1184@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1185make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1186make_abs_section make_function_type
1187make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1188make_cleanup make_reference_type
1189make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1190(@value{GDBP}) b make_
1191@end example
1192
1193@noindent
1194After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1195partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1196command.
1197
1198If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1199can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1200means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1201key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1202one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1203
1204@cindex quotes in commands
1205@cindex completion of quoted strings
1206Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1207parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1208its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1209situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1210@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1211
c906108c
SS
1212The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1213name of a C++ function. This is because C++ allows function overloading
1214(multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by argument
1215type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you may need to
1216distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that takes an
1217@code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version that takes a
1218@code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the word-completion
1219facilities in this situation, type a single quote @code{'} at the
1220beginning of the function name. This alerts @value{GDBN} that it may need to
1221consider more information than usual when you press @key{TAB} or
1222@kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1223
1224@example
1225(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @key{M-?}
1226bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1227(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1228@end example
1229
1230In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1231quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1232completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1233place:
1234
1235@example
1236(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1237@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1238(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1239@end example
1240
1241@noindent
1242In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1243you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1244completion on an overloaded symbol.
1245
d4f3574e 1246For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
c906108c
SS
1247expressions, ,C++ expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1248overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
d4f3574e 1249see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C++}.
c906108c
SS
1250
1251
53a5351d 1252@node Help
c906108c
SS
1253@section Getting help
1254@cindex online documentation
1255@kindex help
1256
1257You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1258using the command @code{help}.
1259
1260@table @code
1261@kindex h
1262@item help
1263@itemx h
1264You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1265display a short list of named classes of commands:
1266
1267@smallexample
1268(@value{GDBP}) help
1269List of classes of commands:
1270
2df3850c 1271aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1272breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1273data -- Examining data
c906108c 1274files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1275internals -- Maintenance commands
1276obscure -- Obscure features
1277running -- Running the program
1278stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1279status -- Status inquiries
1280support -- Support facilities
2df3850c 1281tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without stopping the program
c906108c 1282user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c
SS
1283
1284Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1285commands in that class.
1286Type "help" followed by command name for full
1287documentation.
1288Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1289(@value{GDBP})
1290@end smallexample
1291
1292@item help @var{class}
1293Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1294list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1295help display for the class @code{status}:
1296
1297@smallexample
1298(@value{GDBP}) help status
1299Status inquiries.
1300
1301List of commands:
1302
1303@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1304@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1305info -- Generic command for showing things
1306 about the program being debugged
1307show -- Generic command for showing things
1308 about the debugger
c906108c
SS
1309
1310Type "help" followed by command name for full
1311documentation.
1312Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1313(@value{GDBP})
1314@end smallexample
1315
1316@item help @var{command}
1317With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1318short paragraph on how to use that command.
1319
1320@kindex complete
1321@item complete @var{args}
1322The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1323for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1324command you want completed. For example:
1325
1326@smallexample
1327complete i
1328@end smallexample
1329
1330@noindent results in:
1331
1332@smallexample
1333@group
2df3850c
JM
1334if
1335ignore
c906108c
SS
1336info
1337inspect
c906108c
SS
1338@end group
1339@end smallexample
1340
1341@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1342@end table
1343
1344In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1345and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1346of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1347manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1348under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1349all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1350
1351@c @group
1352@table @code
1353@kindex info
1354@kindex i
1355@item info
1356This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1357program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1358with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1359registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1360You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1361@w{@code{help info}}.
1362
1363@kindex set
1364@item set
1365You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1366@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1367@code{set prompt $}.
1368
1369@kindex show
1370@item show
1371In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1372@value{GDBN} itself.
1373You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1374related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1375system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1376which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1377
1378@kindex info set
1379To display all the settable parameters and their current
1380values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1381@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1382@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1383@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1384@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1385@end table
1386@c @end group
1387
1388Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1389exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1390
1391@table @code
1392@kindex show version
1393@cindex version number
1394@item show version
1395Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1396information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1397@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1398version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1399commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1400system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1401variant versions of @value{GDBN} in GNU/Linux distributions as well.
1402The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1403@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1404
1405@kindex show copying
1406@item show copying
1407Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1408
1409@kindex show warranty
1410@item show warranty
2df3850c
JM
1411Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1412if your version of @value{GDB} comes with one.
1413
c906108c
SS
1414@end table
1415
53a5351d 1416@node Running
c906108c
SS
1417@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1418
1419When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1420debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1421
1422You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1423of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1424your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1425kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1426
1427@menu
1428* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1429* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1430* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1431* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1432
1433* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1434* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1435* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1436* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1437
1438* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1439* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1440@end menu
1441
53a5351d 1442@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1443@section Compiling for debugging
1444
1445In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1446debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1447is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1448variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1449and addresses in the executable code.
1450
1451To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1452the compiler.
1453
1454Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1455options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1456executables containing debugging information.
1457
53a5351d
JM
1458@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1459without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1460recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1461program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1462in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1463
1464@cindex optimized code, debugging
1465@cindex debugging optimized code
1466When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1467optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1468really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1469exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1470variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1471variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1472
1473Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1474@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1475doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1476please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1477
1478Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1479@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1480format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1481
1482@need 2000
53a5351d 1483@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1484@section Starting your program
1485@cindex starting
1486@cindex running
1487
1488@table @code
1489@kindex run
1490@item run
1491@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1492Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1493You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1494argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1495@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1496(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1497
1498@end table
1499
c906108c
SS
1500If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1501supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1502that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1503@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1504
1505The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1506receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1507information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1508can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1509your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1510divided into four categories:
1511
1512@table @asis
1513@item The @emph{arguments.}
1514Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1515@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1516is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1517(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1518the arguments.
1519In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1520@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1521@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1522
1523@item The @emph{environment.}
1524Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1525use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1526environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1527your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1528
1529@item The @emph{working directory.}
1530Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1531the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1532@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1533
1534@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1535Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1536standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1537in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1538set a different device for your program.
1539@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1540
1541@cindex pipes
1542@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1543pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1544program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1545wrong program.
1546@end table
c906108c
SS
1547
1548When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1549immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1550of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1551stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1552or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1553
1554If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1555time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1556table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1557your current breakpoints.
1558
53a5351d 1559@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1560@section Your program's arguments
1561
1562@cindex arguments (to your program)
1563The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1564@code{run} command.
1565They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1566performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1567@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1568@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1569the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1570
1571On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1572@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1573calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1574the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1575
1576@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1577@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1578
1579@kindex set args
1580@table @code
1581@item set args
1582Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1583@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1584with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1585using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1586it again without arguments.
1587
1588@kindex show args
1589@item show args
1590Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1591@end table
1592
53a5351d 1593@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1594@section Your program's environment
1595
1596@cindex environment (of your program)
1597The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1598their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1599your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1600path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1601the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1602debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1603environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1604
1605@table @code
1606@kindex path
1607@item path @var{directory}
1608Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1609(the search path for executables), for both @value{GDBN} and your program.
d4f3574e
SS
1610You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1611system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1612MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1613is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1614
1615You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1616working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1617use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1618@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1619@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1620@var{directory} to the search path.
1621@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1622@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1623
1624@kindex show paths
1625@item show paths
1626Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1627environment variable).
1628
1629@kindex show environment
1630@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1631Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1632your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1633print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1634your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1635
1636@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1637@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1638Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1639changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1640be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1641any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1642parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1643null value.
1644@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1645@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1646
1647For example, this command:
1648
1649@example
1650set env USER = foo
1651@end example
1652
1653@noindent
d4f3574e 1654tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1655@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1656are not actually required.)
1657
1658@kindex unset environment
1659@item unset environment @var{varname}
1660Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1661program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1662@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1663rather than assigning it an empty value.
1664@end table
1665
d4f3574e
SS
1666@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1667the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1668by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1669@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1670that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1671@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1672your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1673files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1674@file{.profile}.
1675
53a5351d 1676@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1677@section Your program's working directory
1678
1679@cindex working directory (of your program)
1680Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1681working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1682The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1683from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1684working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1685
1686The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1687that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1688specify files}.
1689
1690@table @code
1691@kindex cd
1692@item cd @var{directory}
1693Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1694
1695@kindex pwd
1696@item pwd
1697Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1698@end table
1699
53a5351d 1700@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1701@section Your program's input and output
1702
1703@cindex redirection
1704@cindex i/o
1705@cindex terminal
1706By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
1707the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
1708to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1709modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1710running your program.
1711
1712@table @code
1713@kindex info terminal
1714@item info terminal
1715Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1716program is using.
1717@end table
1718
1719You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1720redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1721
1722@example
1723run > outfile
1724@end example
1725
1726@noindent
1727starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1728
1729@kindex tty
1730@cindex controlling terminal
1731Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1732with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1733argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1734commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1735process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1736
1737@example
1738tty /dev/ttyb
1739@end example
1740
1741@noindent
1742directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1743default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1744that as their controlling terminal.
1745
1746An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1747effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1748terminal.
1749
1750When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1751command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1752for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1753
53a5351d 1754@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1755@section Debugging an already-running process
1756@kindex attach
1757@cindex attach
1758
1759@table @code
1760@item attach @var{process-id}
1761This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1762outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1763targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1764find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1765or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1766
1767@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1768executing the command.
1769@end table
1770
1771To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1772which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1773programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1774also have permission to send the process a signal.
1775
1776When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1777the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1778the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1779(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1780the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1781Specify Files}.
1782
1783The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1784process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1785with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1786you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1787can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1788process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1789attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1790
1791@table @code
1792@kindex detach
1793@item detach
1794When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1795@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1796the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1797that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1798are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1799@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1800executing the command.
1801@end table
1802
1803If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1804attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1805for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1806control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1807confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1808messages}).
1809
53a5351d 1810@node Kill Process
c906108c 1811@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1812
1813@table @code
1814@kindex kill
1815@item kill
1816Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1817@end table
1818
1819This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1820running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1821is running.
1822
1823On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
1824while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
1825@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
1826outside the debugger.
1827
1828The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
1829relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
1830executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
1831next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
1832reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
1833breakpoint settings).
1834
53a5351d 1835@node Threads
c906108c 1836@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
1837
1838@cindex threads of execution
1839@cindex multiple threads
1840@cindex switching threads
1841In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
1842may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
1843of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
1844the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
1845that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
1846modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
1847registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
1848
1849@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
1850programs:
1851
1852@itemize @bullet
1853@item automatic notification of new threads
1854@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
1855@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
1856@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
1857a command to apply a command to a list of threads
1858@item thread-specific breakpoints
1859@end itemize
1860
c906108c
SS
1861@quotation
1862@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
1863@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
1864If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
1865effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
1866from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
1867like this:
1868
1869@smallexample
1870(@value{GDBP}) info threads
1871(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
1872Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
1873see the IDs of currently known threads.
1874@end smallexample
1875@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
1876@c doesn't support threads"?
1877@end quotation
c906108c
SS
1878
1879@cindex focus of debugging
1880@cindex current thread
1881The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
1882threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
1883control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
1884This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
1885program information from the perspective of the current thread.
1886
c906108c
SS
1887@kindex New @var{systag}
1888@cindex thread identifier (system)
1889@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1890@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1891@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1892Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1893the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1894form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1895whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
1896LynxOS, you might see
1897
1898@example
1899[New process 35 thread 27]
1900@end example
1901
1902@noindent
1903when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
1904the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
1905further qualifier.
1906
1907@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
1908@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
1909@c second---i.e., when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
1910@c program?
1911@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
1912@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
1913@c threads ab initio?
1914
1915@cindex thread number
1916@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
1917For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
1918number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
1919
1920@table @code
1921@kindex info threads
1922@item info threads
1923Display a summary of all threads currently in your
1924program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
1925
1926@enumerate
1927@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
1928
1929@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
1930
1931@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
1932@end enumerate
1933
1934@noindent
1935An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
1936indicates the current thread.
1937
1938For example,
1939@end table
1940@c end table here to get a little more width for example
1941
1942@smallexample
1943(@value{GDBP}) info threads
1944 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
1945 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
1946* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
1947 at threadtest.c:68
1948@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
1949
1950On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
1951
1952@cindex thread number
1953@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
1954For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
1955number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
1956thread in your program.
1957
1958@kindex New @var{systag}
1959@cindex thread identifier (system)
1960@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1961@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1962@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1963Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1964both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1965form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1966whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
1967HP-UX, you see
1968
1969@example
1970[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
1971@end example
1972
1973@noindent
1974when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
1975
1976@table @code
1977@kindex info threads
1978@item info threads
1979Display a summary of all threads currently in your
1980program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
1981
1982@enumerate
1983@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
1984
1985@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
1986
1987@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
1988@end enumerate
1989
1990@noindent
1991An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
1992indicates the current thread.
1993
1994For example,
1995@end table
1996@c end table here to get a little more width for example
1997
1998@example
1999(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2000 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") at quicksort.c:137
2001 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () from /usr/lib/libc.2
2002 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () from /usr/lib/libc.2
2003@end example
c906108c
SS
2004
2005@table @code
2006@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2007@item thread @var{threadno}
2008Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2009argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2010shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2011@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2012you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2013
2014@smallexample
2015@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2016(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 2017[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
20180x34e5 in sigpause ()
2019@end smallexample
2020
2021@noindent
2022As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2023@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2024threads.
2025
2026@kindex thread apply
2027@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2028The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2029more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2030with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2031@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
2032threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2033@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
2034@end table
2035
2036@cindex automatic thread selection
2037@cindex switching threads automatically
2038@cindex threads, automatic switching
2039Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2040signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2041signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2042message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2043thread.
2044
2045@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2046more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2047programs with multiple threads.
2048
2049@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2050watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 2051
53a5351d 2052@node Processes
c906108c
SS
2053@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2054
2055@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2056@cindex multiple processes
2057@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
2058On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2059programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2060function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2061parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2062set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2063will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2064will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
2065
2066However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2067which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2068the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2069only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2070so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2071on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2072get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2073@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 2074the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 2075the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 2076
53a5351d
JM
2077On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2078debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2079@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
2080
2081By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2082the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2083
2084If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2085use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2086
2087@table @code
2088@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2089@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2090Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2091@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2092process. The @var{mode} can be:
2093
2094@table @code
2095@item parent
2096The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 2097unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
2098
2099@item child
2100The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2101unimpeded.
2102
2103@item ask
2104The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2105@end table
2106
2107@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 2108Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2109@end table
2110
2111If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2112@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2113breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2114@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2115the child process's @code{main}.
2116
2117When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2118child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2119
2120If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2121call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2122use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2123argument.
2124
2125You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2126a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2127Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2128
53a5351d 2129@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2130@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2131
2132The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2133program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2134trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2135
7a292a7a
SS
2136Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2137such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2138@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2139change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2140continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2141ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2142explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2143
2144@table @code
2145@kindex info program
2146@item info program
2147Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2148running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2149@end table
2150
2151@menu
2152* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2153* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2154* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2155* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2156@end menu
2157
53a5351d 2158@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2159@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2160
2161@cindex breakpoints
2162A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2163the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2164control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2165breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2166Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2167should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2168program.
2169
2170In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2171breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2172a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2173is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2174not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2175arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2176
2177@cindex watchpoints
2178@cindex memory tracing
2179@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2180@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2181A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2182when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2183command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2184watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2185any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2186and watchpoints using the same commands.
2187
2188You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2189whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2190Automatic display}.
2191
2192@cindex catchpoints
2193@cindex breakpoint on events
2194A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2195when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C++
2196exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2197different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2198catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2199other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2200@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2201
2202@cindex breakpoint numbers
2203@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2204@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2205catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2206starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2207features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2208breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2209@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2210enable it again.
2211
c5394b80
JM
2212@cindex breakpoint ranges
2213@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2214Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2215operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2216@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2217hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2218all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2219
c906108c
SS
2220@menu
2221* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2222* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2223* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2224* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2225* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2226* Conditions:: Break conditions
2227* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2228* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2229* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2230@end menu
2231
53a5351d 2232@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2233@subsection Setting breakpoints
2234
2235@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2236@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2237@c
2238@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2239
2240@kindex break
2241@kindex b
2242@kindex $bpnum
2243@cindex latest breakpoint
2244Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2245@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2246number of the breakpoints you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2247Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2248convenience variables.
2249
2250You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2251
2252@table @code
2253@item break @var{function}
2254Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c
SS
2255When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2256C++, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2257@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2258
2259@item break +@var{offset}
2260@itemx break -@var{offset}
2261Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2262at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2263(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2264
2265@item break @var{linenum}
2266Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2267The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2268The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2269code on that line.
2270
2271@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2272Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2273
2274@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2275Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2276@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2277superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2278functions.
2279
2280@item break *@var{address}
2281Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2282breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2283information or source files.
2284
2285@item break
2286When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2287the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2288(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2289innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2290returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2291@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2292that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2293@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2294the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2295inside loops.
2296
2297@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2298least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2299would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2300breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2301existed when your program stopped.
2302
2303@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2304Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2305@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2306value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2307@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2308above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2309,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2310
2311@kindex tbreak
2312@item tbreak @var{args}
2313Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2314same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2315way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2316program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2317
c906108c
SS
2318@kindex hbreak
2319@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2320Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2321@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2322breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2323have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2324debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2325changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2326provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2327will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2328address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2329breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2330example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2331@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2332or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2333(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2334
2335@kindex thbreak
2336@item thbreak @var{args}
2337Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2338are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2339the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2340the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2341first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2342command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2343may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2344See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2345
2346@kindex rbreak
2347@cindex regular expression
2348@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2349Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2350@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2351matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2352breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2353the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2354them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2355
2356The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2357like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2358shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2359an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2360@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2361match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2362
c906108c
SS
2363When debugging C++ programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2364breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2365classes.
c906108c
SS
2366
2367@kindex info breakpoints
2368@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2369@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2370@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2371@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2372Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2373not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2374
2375@table @emph
2376@item Breakpoint Numbers
2377@item Type
2378Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2379@item Disposition
2380Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2381@item Enabled or Disabled
2382Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2383that are not enabled.
2384@item Address
2df3850c 2385Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2386@item What
2387Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2388line number.
2389@end table
2390
2391@noindent
2392If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2393the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2394are listed after that.
2395
2396@noindent
2397@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2398number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2399convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2400the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
2401listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
2402
2403@noindent
2404@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2405has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2406@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2407hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2408was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2409will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2410@end table
2411
2412@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2413your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2414the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2415(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2416
2417@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2418@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2419@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for special
2420purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C programs).
2421These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers, starting with
2422@code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2423
2424You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2425@samp{maint info breakpoints}.
2426
2427@table @code
2428@kindex maint info breakpoints
2429@item maint info breakpoints
2430Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
2431breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
2432internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
2433breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
2434is shown:
2435
2436@table @code
2437@item breakpoint
2438Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
2439
2440@item watchpoint
2441Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
2442
2443@item longjmp
2444Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
2445@code{longjmp} calls.
2446
2447@item longjmp resume
2448Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
2449
2450@item until
2451Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
2452
2453@item finish
2454Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
2455
c906108c
SS
2456@item shlib events
2457Shared library events.
53a5351d 2458
c906108c 2459@end table
53a5351d 2460
c906108c
SS
2461@end table
2462
2463
53a5351d 2464@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2465@subsection Setting watchpoints
2466
2467@cindex setting watchpoints
2468@cindex software watchpoints
2469@cindex hardware watchpoints
2470You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2471expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2472this may happen.
2473
2474Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2475hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2476program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2477times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2478catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2479culprit.)
2480
d4f3574e 2481On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2482@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2483hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2484program.
2485
2486@table @code
2487@kindex watch
2488@item watch @var{expr}
2489Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2490is written into by the program and its value changes.
2491
2492@kindex rwatch
2493@item rwatch @var{expr}
2494Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2495
2496@kindex awatch
2497@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2498Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2499by the program.
c906108c
SS
2500
2501@kindex info watchpoints
2502@item info watchpoints
2503This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2504it is the same as @code{info break}.
2505@end table
2506
2507@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2508watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2509value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2510cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2511executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2512statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2513
2514When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2515
2516@example
2517Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2518@end example
2519
2520@noindent
2521if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2522
7be570e7
JM
2523Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2524hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2525value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2526every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2527that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2528hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2529will print a message like this:
2530
2531@smallexample
2532Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2533@end smallexample
2534
2535Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2536data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2537watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2538can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2539cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2540double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2541wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2542into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2543
2544If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2545to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2546Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2547time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2548able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2549warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2550
2551@smallexample
2552Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2553@end smallexample
2554
2555@noindent
2556If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2557
2558The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2559or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2560data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2561hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2562both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2563watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2564@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2565watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2566@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2567Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2568
2569If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2570any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2571kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2572
7be570e7
JM
2573@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2574(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2575they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2576which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2577being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2578and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2579rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2580way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2581@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2582
c906108c
SS
2583@quotation
2584@cindex watchpoints and threads
2585@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2586@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2587usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2588can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2589you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2590thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2591can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2592@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2593the expression.
53a5351d 2594
d4f3574e 2595@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2596@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2597have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2598watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2599single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2600change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2601confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2602software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2603when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2604watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2605@end quotation
c906108c 2606
53a5351d 2607@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2608@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2609@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2610@cindex exception handlers
2611@cindex event handling
2612
2613You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
2614kinds of program events, such as C++ exceptions or the loading of a
2615shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2616
2617@table @code
2618@kindex catch
2619@item catch @var{event}
2620Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2621@table @code
2622@item throw
2623@kindex catch throw
2624The throwing of a C++ exception.
2625
2626@item catch
2627@kindex catch catch
2628The catching of a C++ exception.
2629
2630@item exec
2631@kindex catch exec
2632A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2633
2634@item fork
2635@kindex catch fork
2636A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2637
2638@item vfork
2639@kindex catch vfork
2640A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2641
2642@item load
2643@itemx load @var{libname}
2644@kindex catch load
2645The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2646@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2647
2648@item unload
2649@itemx unload @var{libname}
2650@kindex catch unload
2651The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2652of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2653@end table
2654
2655@item tcatch @var{event}
2656Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2657automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2658
2659@end table
2660
2661Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2662
2663There are currently some limitations to C++ exception handling
2664(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2665
2666@itemize @bullet
2667@item
2668If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2669control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2670raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2671returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2672simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2673that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2674you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2675disabled within interactive calls.
2676
2677@item
2678You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2679
2680@item
2681You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2682@end itemize
2683
2684@cindex raise exceptions
2685Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2686if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2687stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2688can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2689breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2690out where the exception was raised.
2691
2692To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
2693knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C++, exceptions are
2694raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2695which has the following ANSI C interface:
2696
2697@example
2698 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2699 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2700 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
c906108c
SS
2701@end example
2702
2703@noindent
2704To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2705unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2706(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2707
2708With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2709that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2710a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2711breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2712raised.
2713
2714
53a5351d 2715@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2716@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2717
2718@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2719@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2720It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2721catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2722to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2723breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2724
2725With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2726where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2727delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2728their breakpoint numbers.
2729
2730It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2731automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2732when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2733
2734@table @code
2735@kindex clear
2736@item clear
2737Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2738selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2739the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2740breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2741
2742@item clear @var{function}
2743@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2744Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2745
2746@item clear @var{linenum}
2747@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2748Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2749
2750@cindex delete breakpoints
2751@kindex delete
2752@kindex d
c5394b80
JM
2753@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2754Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2755ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
2756breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2757confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2758@end table
2759
53a5351d 2760@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2761@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2762
2763@kindex disable breakpoints
2764@kindex enable breakpoints
2765Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2766prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2767it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2768that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2769
2770You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2771the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2772or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2773@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2774catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2775
2776A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2777states of enablement:
2778
2779@itemize @bullet
2780@item
2781Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2782with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2783@item
2784Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2785@item
2786Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2787disabled.
c906108c
SS
2788@item
2789Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2790immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2791set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2792@end itemize
2793
2794You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2795watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2796
2797@table @code
2798@kindex disable breakpoints
2799@kindex disable
2800@kindex dis
c5394b80 2801@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2802Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2803listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2804options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2805case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2806@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2807
2808@kindex enable breakpoints
2809@kindex enable
c5394b80 2810@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2811Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2812become effective once again in stopping your program.
2813
c5394b80 2814@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2815Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2816of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2817
c5394b80 2818@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2819Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2820deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2821@end table
2822
d4f3574e
SS
2823@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2824@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2825Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2826,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2827subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2828the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2829breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2830breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2831stepping}.)
2832
53a5351d 2833@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2834@subsection Break conditions
2835@cindex conditional breakpoints
2836@cindex breakpoint conditions
2837
2838@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
2839@c in particular for a watchpoint?
2840The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2841specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2842breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2843programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2844a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2845and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2846
2847This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2848situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2849when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2850by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2851@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2852
2853Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2854since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2855it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
2856and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
2857one.
2858
2859Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
2860your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
2861that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
2862format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
2863unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
2864that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
2865program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
2866breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
2867conditions for the
c906108c
SS
2868purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
2869(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
2870
2871Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
2872@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
2873Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
2874with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 2875
c906108c
SS
2876You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
2877The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
2878@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
2879catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
2880
2881@table @code
2882@kindex condition
2883@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
2884Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
2885watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
2886breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
2887@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
2888@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
2889syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
2890referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
2891symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
2892prints an error message:
2893
2894@example
2895No symbol "foo" in current context.
2896@end example
2897
2898@noindent
c906108c
SS
2899@value{GDBN} does
2900not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
2901command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
2902@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
2903
2904@item condition @var{bnum}
2905Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
2906an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
2907@end table
2908
2909@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
2910A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
2911breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
2912useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
2913count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
2914is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
2915therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
2916ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
2917the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
2918value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
2919your program reaches it.
2920
2921@table @code
2922@kindex ignore
2923@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
2924Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
2925The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
2926execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
2927takes no action.
2928
2929To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
2930a count of zero.
2931
2932When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
2933breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
2934@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
2935Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
2936
2937If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
2938condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
2939@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
2940
2941You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
2942as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
2943is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
2944variables}.
2945@end table
2946
2947Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
2948
2949
53a5351d 2950@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
2951@subsection Breakpoint command lists
2952
2953@cindex breakpoint commands
2954You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
2955commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
2956example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
2957enable other breakpoints.
2958
2959@table @code
2960@kindex commands
2961@kindex end
2962@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
2963@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
2964@itemx end
2965Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
2966themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
2967@code{end} to terminate the commands.
2968
2969To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
2970follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
2971
2972With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
2973breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
2974recently encountered).
2975@end table
2976
2977Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
2978disabled within a @var{command-list}.
2979
2980You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
2981use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
2982that resumes execution.
2983
2984Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
2985execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
2986(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
2987another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
2988ambiguities about which list to execute.
2989
2990@kindex silent
2991If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
2992usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
2993be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
2994then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
2995see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
2996meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
2997
2998The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
2999print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3000breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3001
3002For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3003value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3004
3005@example
3006break foo if x>0
3007commands
3008silent
3009printf "x is %d\n",x
3010cont
3011end
3012@end example
3013
3014One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3015you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3016of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3017erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3018to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3019so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3020command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3021
3022@example
3023break 403
3024commands
3025silent
3026set x = y + 4
3027cont
3028end
3029@end example
3030
53a5351d 3031@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
3032@subsection Breakpoint menus
3033@cindex overloading
3034@cindex symbol overloading
3035
3036Some programming languages (notably C++) permit a single function name
3037to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3038This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3039@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3040a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3041something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3042particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3043you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3044waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3045options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3046sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3047@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3048breakpoints.
3049
3050For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3051breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3052We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3053
3054@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3055@smallexample
3056@group
3057(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3058[0] cancel
3059[1] all
3060[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3061[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3062[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3063[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3064[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3065[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3066> 2 4 6
3067Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3068Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3069Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3070Multiple breakpoints were set.
3071Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3072 breakpoints.
3073(@value{GDBP})
3074@end group
3075@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3076
3077@c @ifclear BARETARGET
d4f3574e
SS
3078@node Error in Breakpoints
3079@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
3080@c
3081@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3082@c
d4f3574e
SS
3083Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3084any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3085attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3086@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3087
3088@example
3089Cannot insert breakpoints.
3090The same program may be running in another process.
3091@end example
3092
3093When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3094
3095@enumerate
3096@item
3097Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3098
3099@item
3100Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3101name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3102that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3103Then start your program again.
3104
3105@item
3106Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3107linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3108to nonsharable executables.
3109@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3110@c @end ifclear
3111
d4f3574e
SS
3112A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3113hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3114
3115@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3116@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3117@smallexample
3118Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3119You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3120@end smallexample
3121
3122@noindent
3123This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3124only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3125watchpoints it needs to insert.
3126
3127When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3128hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3129
3130
53a5351d 3131@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3132@section Continuing and stepping
3133
3134@cindex stepping
3135@cindex continuing
3136@cindex resuming execution
3137@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3138completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3139one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3140line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3141particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3142your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3143it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3144@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3145
3146@table @code
3147@kindex continue
3148@kindex c
3149@kindex fg
3150@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3151@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3152@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3153Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3154any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3155@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3156ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3157@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3158
3159The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3160stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3161@code{continue} is ignored.
3162
d4f3574e
SS
3163The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3164debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3165purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3166@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3167@end table
3168
3169To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3170(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3171calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3172different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3173
3174A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3175(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3176beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3177is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3178and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3179interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3180
3181@table @code
3182@kindex step
3183@kindex s
3184@item step
3185Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3186line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3187abbreviated @code{s}.
3188
3189@quotation
3190@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3191@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3192@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3193@c distinction here.
3194@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3195within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3196execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3197debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3198is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3199without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3200below.
3201@end quotation
3202
d4f3574e
SS
3203The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3204source line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
c906108c
SS
3205switch statements, for loops, etc. @code{step} continues to stop if a
3206function that has debugging information is called within the line.
d4f3574e
SS
3207In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions called
3208within the line.
c906108c 3209
d4f3574e
SS
3210Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3211number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
c906108c
SS
3212@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3213on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3214was any debugging information about the routine.
3215
3216@item step @var{count}
3217Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3218breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3219@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3220
3221@kindex next
3222@kindex n
3223@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3224Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3225This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3226the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3227control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3228that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3229is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3230
3231An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3232
3233
3234@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3235@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3236@c
3237@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3238@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3239@c function are executed without stopping.
3240
d4f3574e
SS
3241The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3242source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
c906108c
SS
3243switch statements, for loops, etc.
3244
3245@kindex finish
3246@item finish
3247Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3248returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3249
3250Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3251,Returning from a function}).
3252
3253@kindex until
3254@kindex u
3255@item until
3256@itemx u
3257Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3258current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3259stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3260command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3261automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3262than the address of the jump.
3263
3264This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3265though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3266exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3267simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3268through the next iteration.
3269
3270@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3271stack frame.
3272
3273@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3274of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3275example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3276(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3277@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3278
3279@example
3280(@value{GDBP}) f
3281#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3282206 expand_input();
3283(@value{GDBP}) until
3284195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3285@end example
3286
3287This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3288generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3289start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3290written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3291to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3292expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3293statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3294
3295@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3296instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3297argument.
3298
3299@item until @var{location}
3300@itemx u @var{location}
3301Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3302reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3303the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3304,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3305and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3306
3307@kindex stepi
3308@kindex si
3309@item stepi
3310@itemx si
3311Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3312
3313It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3314instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3315instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3316Display,, Automatic display}.
3317
3318An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3319
3320@need 750
3321@kindex nexti
3322@kindex ni
3323@item nexti
3324@itemx ni
3325Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3326proceed until the function returns.
3327
3328An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3329@end table
3330
53a5351d 3331@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3332@section Signals
3333@cindex signals
3334
3335A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3336operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3337kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3338signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3339@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3340memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3341the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3342requested an alarm).
3343
3344@cindex fatal signals
3345Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3346functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3347errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3348program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3349@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3350fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3351
3352@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3353program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3354signal.
3355
3356@cindex handling signals
3357Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to ignore non-erroneous signals like @code{SIGALRM}
3358(so as not to interfere with their role in the functioning of your program)
3359but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3360You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3361
3362@table @code
3363@kindex info signals
3364@item info signals
3365Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3366handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3367the defined types of signals.
3368
d4f3574e 3369@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3370
3371@kindex handle
3372@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
3373Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can
3374be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the @samp{SIG} at the
3375beginning). The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
3376@end table
3377
3378@c @group
3379The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3380Their full names are:
3381
3382@table @code
3383@item nostop
3384@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3385still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3386
3387@item stop
3388@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3389the @code{print} keyword as well.
3390
3391@item print
3392@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3393
3394@item noprint
3395@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3396implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3397
3398@item pass
3399@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3400can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
3401and not handled.
3402
3403@item nopass
3404@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
3405@end table
3406@c @end group
3407
d4f3574e
SS
3408When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3409program until you
c906108c
SS
3410continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3411effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3412after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3413command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3414program sees that signal when you continue.
3415
3416You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3417seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3418or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3419due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3420values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3421execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3422a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3423you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
3424program a signal}.
c906108c 3425
53a5351d 3426@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3427@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3428
3429When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3430programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3431breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3432
3433@table @code
3434@cindex breakpoints and threads
3435@cindex thread breakpoints
3436@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3437@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3438@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3439@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3440writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3441
3442Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3443to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3444particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3445numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3446column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3447
3448If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3449breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3450program.
3451
3452You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3453well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3454breakpoint condition, like this:
3455
3456@smallexample
2df3850c 3457(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3458@end smallexample
3459
3460@end table
3461
3462@cindex stopped threads
3463@cindex threads, stopped
3464Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3465@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3466allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3467switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3468underfoot.
3469
3470@cindex continuing threads
3471@cindex threads, continuing
3472Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3473executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
3474like @code{step} or @code{next}.
3475
3476In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3477Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3478system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3479execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3480single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3481statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3482stops.
3483
3484You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3485continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3486thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3487first thread completes whatever you requested.
3488
3489On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3490thread to run.
3491
3492@table @code
3493@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3494Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3495locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3496current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3497mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3498``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3499stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3500when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3501function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3502like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3503thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3504@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3505
3506@item show scheduler-locking
3507Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3508@end table
3509
c906108c 3510
53a5351d 3511@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3512@chapter Examining the Stack
3513
3514When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3515stopped and how it got there.
3516
3517@cindex call stack
3518Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3519is generated.
3520That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3521the arguments of the call,
3522and the local variables of the function being called.
3523The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
3524The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3525stack}.
3526
3527When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3528stack allow you to see all of this information.
3529
3530@cindex selected frame
3531One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3532@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3533particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3534your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3535special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3536interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3537
3538When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
3539currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
3540@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3541
3542@menu
3543* Frames:: Stack frames
3544* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3545* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3546* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3547
3548@end menu
3549
53a5351d 3550@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3551@section Stack frames
3552
d4f3574e 3553@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3554@cindex stack frame
3555The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3556frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3557with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3558to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3559which the function is executing.
3560
3561@cindex initial frame
3562@cindex outermost frame
3563@cindex innermost frame
3564When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3565function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3566@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3567made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3568is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3569the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3570actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3571recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3572
3573@cindex frame pointer
3574Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3575stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3576kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3577address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3578in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3579going on in that frame.
3580
3581@cindex frame number
3582@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3583zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3584and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3585they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3586frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3587
3588@c below produces an acceptable overful hbox. --mew 13aug1993
3589@cindex frameless execution
3590Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
3591without stack frames. (For example, the @code{@value{GCC}} option
3592@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer} generates functions without a frame.)
3593This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3594the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3595with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3596has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3597it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3598correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3599no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3600
3601@table @code
d4f3574e 3602@kindex frame@r{, command}
c906108c
SS
3603@item frame @var{args}
3604The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
3605and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
3606address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3607@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
3608
3609@kindex select-frame
3610@item select-frame
3611The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3612to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3613@code{frame}.
3614@end table
3615
53a5351d 3616@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3617@section Backtraces
3618
3619@cindex backtraces
3620@cindex tracebacks
3621@cindex stack traces
3622A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3623line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3624frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3625stack.
3626
3627@table @code
3628@kindex backtrace
3629@kindex bt
3630@item backtrace
3631@itemx bt
3632Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3633frames in the stack.
3634
3635You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3636character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3637
3638@item backtrace @var{n}
3639@itemx bt @var{n}
3640Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3641
3642@item backtrace -@var{n}
3643@itemx bt -@var{n}
3644Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3645@end table
3646
3647@kindex where
3648@kindex info stack
3649@kindex info s
3650The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3651are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3652
3653Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3654The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3655print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3656line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3657counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3658line number.
3659
3660Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3661@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3662
3663@smallexample
3664@group
3665#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
3666 at builtin.c:993
3667#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3668#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3669 at macro.c:71
3670(More stack frames follow...)
3671@end group
3672@end smallexample
3673
3674@noindent
3675The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3676value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3677code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3678
53a5351d 3679@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3680@section Selecting a frame
3681
3682Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3683whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3684selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3685of the stack frame just selected.
3686
3687@table @code
d4f3574e 3688@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
c906108c
SS
3689@kindex f
3690@item frame @var{n}
3691@itemx f @var{n}
3692Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3693(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3694innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3695@code{main}.
3696
3697@item frame @var{addr}
3698@itemx f @var{addr}
3699Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3700chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3701impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3702addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3703switches between them.
3704
c906108c
SS
3705On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3706select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3707
3708On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3709pointer and a program counter.
3710
3711On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3712pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3713@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3714@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3715@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3716
3717@kindex up
3718@item up @var{n}
3719Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3720advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3721that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3722
3723@kindex down
3724@kindex do
3725@item down @var{n}
3726Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3727advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3728that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3729abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3730@end table
3731
3732All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3733frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3734arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
3735frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
3736
3737@need 1000
3738For example:
3739
3740@smallexample
3741@group
3742(@value{GDBP}) up
3743#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3744 at env.c:10
374510 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3746@end group
3747@end smallexample
3748
3749After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3750prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3751@xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3752
3753@table @code
3754@kindex down-silently
3755@kindex up-silently
3756@item up-silently @var{n}
3757@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3758These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3759respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3760causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3761in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3762distracting.
3763@end table
3764
53a5351d 3765@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
3766@section Information about a frame
3767
3768There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3769stack frame.
3770
3771@table @code
3772@item frame
3773@itemx f
3774When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3775frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3776selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3777argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3778@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3779
3780@kindex info frame
3781@kindex info f
3782@item info frame
3783@itemx info f
3784This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3785including:
3786
3787@itemize @bullet
3788@item
3789the address of the frame
3790@item
3791the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3792@item
3793the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3794@item
3795the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3796@item
3797the address of the frame's arguments
3798@item
d4f3574e
SS
3799the address of the frame's local variables
3800@item
c906108c
SS
3801the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3802@item
3803which registers were saved in the frame
3804@end itemize
3805
3806@noindent The verbose description is useful when
3807something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3808the usual conventions.
3809
3810@item info frame @var{addr}
3811@itemx info f @var{addr}
3812Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3813selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3814command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3815architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
3816@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3817
3818@kindex info args
3819@item info args
3820Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
3821
3822@item info locals
3823@kindex info locals
3824Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
3825line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
3826accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
3827
c906108c 3828@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
3829@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
3830@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
3831@item info catch
3832Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
3833current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
3834exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
3835@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
3836@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 3837
c906108c
SS
3838@end table
3839
c906108c 3840
53a5351d 3841@node Source
c906108c
SS
3842@chapter Examining Source Files
3843
3844@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
3845information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
3846used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
3847the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
3848(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
3849execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
3850source files by explicit command.
3851
7a292a7a 3852If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 3853prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 3854@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
3855
3856@menu
3857* List:: Printing source lines
c906108c 3858* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
3859* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
3860* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
3861@end menu
3862
53a5351d 3863@node List
c906108c
SS
3864@section Printing source lines
3865
3866@kindex list
3867@kindex l
3868To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
3869(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
3870There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
3871
3872Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
3873
3874@table @code
3875@item list @var{linenum}
3876Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
3877current source file.
3878
3879@item list @var{function}
3880Print lines centered around the beginning of function
3881@var{function}.
3882
3883@item list
3884Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
3885@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
3886printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
3887as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
3888Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
3889
3890@item list -
3891Print lines just before the lines last printed.
3892@end table
3893
3894By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
3895the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
3896
3897@table @code
3898@kindex set listsize
3899@item set listsize @var{count}
3900Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
3901the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
3902
3903@kindex show listsize
3904@item show listsize
3905Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
3906@end table
3907
3908Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
3909so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
3910than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
3911argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
3912each repetition moves up in the source file.
3913
3914@cindex linespec
3915In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
3916@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 3917of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
3918Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
3919
3920@table @code
3921@item list @var{linespec}
3922Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
3923
3924@item list @var{first},@var{last}
3925Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
3926linespecs.
3927
3928@item list ,@var{last}
3929Print lines ending with @var{last}.
3930
3931@item list @var{first},
3932Print lines starting with @var{first}.
3933
3934@item list +
3935Print lines just after the lines last printed.
3936
3937@item list -
3938Print lines just before the lines last printed.
3939
3940@item list
3941As described in the preceding table.
3942@end table
3943
3944Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
3945kinds of linespec.
3946
3947@table @code
3948@item @var{number}
3949Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
3950When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
3951the same source file as the first linespec.
3952
3953@item +@var{offset}
3954Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
3955When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
3956two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
3957first linespec.
3958
3959@item -@var{offset}
3960Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
3961
3962@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
3963Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
3964
3965@item @var{function}
3966Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
3967For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
3968
3969@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
3970Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
3971function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
3972file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
3973identically named functions in different source files.
3974
3975@item *@var{address}
3976Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
3977@var{address} may be any expression.
3978@end table
3979
53a5351d 3980@node Search
c906108c
SS
3981@section Searching source files
3982@cindex searching
3983@kindex reverse-search
3984
3985There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
3986regular expression.
3987
3988@table @code
3989@kindex search
3990@kindex forward-search
3991@item forward-search @var{regexp}
3992@itemx search @var{regexp}
3993The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
3994starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
3995@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
3996synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
3997@code{fo}.
3998
3999@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4000The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4001with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4002for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4003this command as @code{rev}.
4004@end table
c906108c 4005
53a5351d 4006@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
4007@section Specifying source directories
4008
4009@cindex source path
4010@cindex directories for source files
4011Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4012files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4013the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4014session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4015this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4016it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4017in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4018the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4019the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4020path.
4021
4022If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4023object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4024too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4025compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4026last resort.
4027
4028Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4029any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4030each line is in the file.
4031
4032@kindex directory
4033@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
4034When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4035and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
4036To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4037
4038@table @code
4039@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4040@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4041Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
4042directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4043(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4044part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
4045whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4046path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4047
4048@kindex cdir
4049@kindex cwd
4050@kindex $cdir
4051@kindex $cwd
4052@cindex compilation directory
4053@cindex current directory
4054@cindex working directory
4055@cindex directory, current
4056@cindex directory, compilation
4057You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4058directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4059working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4060tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4061session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4062directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4063
4064@item directory
4065Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4066
4067@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4068@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4069
4070@item show directories
4071@kindex show directories
4072Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4073@end table
4074
4075If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4076interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4077versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4078
4079@enumerate
4080@item
4081Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4082
4083@item
4084Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4085directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4086directories in one command.
4087@end enumerate
4088
53a5351d 4089@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
4090@section Source and machine code
4091
4092You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4093addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4094a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 4095mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
c906108c
SS
4096line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
4097well as hex.
4098
4099@table @code
4100@kindex info line
4101@item info line @var{linespec}
4102Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4103source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4104the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4105source lines}).
4106@end table
4107
4108For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4109the object code for the first line of function
4110@code{m4_changequote}:
4111
d4f3574e
SS
4112@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4113@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c
SS
4114@smallexample
4115(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changecom
4116Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4117@end smallexample
4118
4119@noindent
4120We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4121@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4122@smallexample
4123(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4124Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4125@end smallexample
4126
4127@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
d4f3574e 4128@kindex x@r{, and }@code{info line}
c906108c
SS
4129After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4130is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4131sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4132,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4133convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4134variables}).
4135
4136@table @code
4137@kindex disassemble
4138@cindex assembly instructions
4139@cindex instructions, assembly
4140@cindex machine instructions
4141@cindex listing machine instructions
4142@item disassemble
4143This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4144instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4145program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4146command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4147surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4148(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4149@end table
4150
c906108c
SS
4151The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4152HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4153
4154@smallexample
4155(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4156Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
41570x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
41580x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
41590x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
41600x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
41610x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
41620x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
41630x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
41640x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4165End of assembler dump.
4166@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4167
4168Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4169mnemonics or other syntax.
4170
4171@table @code
d4f3574e 4172@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4173@cindex assembly instructions
4174@cindex instructions, assembly
4175@cindex machine instructions
4176@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4177@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4178@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4179@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4180Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4181program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4182
4183Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4184can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4185The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4186assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4187@end table
4188
4189
53a5351d 4190@node Data
c906108c
SS
4191@chapter Examining Data
4192
4193@cindex printing data
4194@cindex examining data
4195@kindex print
4196@kindex inspect
4197@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4198@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4199@c different window or something like that.
4200The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4201command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4202evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4203program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4204Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4205
4206@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4207@item print @var{expr}
4208@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4209@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4210value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4211you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4212@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4213formats}.
4214
4215@item print
4216@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4217If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4218@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4219conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4220@end table
4221
4222A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4223It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4224specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4225
7a292a7a 4226If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4227fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4228command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4229Table}.
c906108c
SS
4230
4231@menu
4232* Expressions:: Expressions
4233* Variables:: Program variables
4234* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4235* Output Formats:: Output formats
4236* Memory:: Examining memory
4237* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4238* Print Settings:: Print settings
4239* Value History:: Value history
4240* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4241* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4242* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
c906108c
SS
4243@end menu
4244
53a5351d 4245@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4246@section Expressions
4247
4248@cindex expressions
4249@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4250compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4251by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4252@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts
4253and string constants. It unfortunately does not include symbols defined
4254by preprocessor @code{#define} commands.
4255
d4f3574e
SS
4256@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4257the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
4258you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
4259memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4260
c906108c
SS
4261Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4262this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4263Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4264languages.
4265
4266In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4267expressions regardless of your programming language.
4268
4269Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4270useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4271at that address in memory.
4272@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4273
4274@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4275to programming languages:
4276
4277@table @code
4278@item @@
4279@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4280@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4281
4282@item ::
4283@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4284function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4285
4286@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4287@cindex type casting memory
4288@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4289@cindex casts, to view memory
4290@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4291Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4292memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4293pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4294a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4295normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4296@end table
4297
53a5351d 4298@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4299@section Program variables
4300
4301The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4302in your program.
4303
4304Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4305(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4306
4307@itemize @bullet
4308@item
4309global (or file-static)
4310@end itemize
4311
4312@noindent or
4313
4314@itemize @bullet
4315@item
4316visible according to the scope rules of the
4317programming language from the point of execution in that frame
4318@end itemize
4319
4320@noindent This means that in the function
4321
4322@example
4323foo (a)
4324 int a;
4325@{
4326 bar (a);
4327 @{
4328 int b = test ();
4329 bar (b);
4330 @}
4331@}
4332@end example
4333
4334@noindent
4335you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4336executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4337examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4338the block where @code{b} is declared.
4339
4340@cindex variable name conflict
4341There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4342scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4343in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4344function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4345happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4346you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4347using the colon-colon notation:
4348
d4f3574e 4349@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4350@iftex
4351@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
4352@kindex ::
4353@end iftex
4354@example
4355@var{file}::@var{variable}
4356@var{function}::@var{variable}
4357@end example
4358
4359@noindent
4360Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4361static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4362make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4363to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4364
4365@example
4366(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4367@end example
4368
c906108c
SS
4369@cindex C++ scope resolution
4370This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
4371use of the same notation in C++. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C++
4372scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4373@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4374@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4375
4376@cindex wrong values
4377@cindex variable values, wrong
4378@quotation
4379@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4380wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4381scope, and just before exit.
4382@end quotation
4383You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4384This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4385set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4386stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4387values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4388also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4389after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4390variable definitions may be gone.
4391
4392This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4393To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4394when compiling.
4395
d4f3574e
SS
4396@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4397Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4398unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4399opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4400offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4401might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4402happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4403
4404@example
4405No symbol "foo" in current context.
4406@end example
4407
4408To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4409different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
4410formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C++ compiler usually
4411supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4412in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
4413to use DWARF-2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
4414debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4415Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4416information.
4417
4418
53a5351d 4419@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4420@section Artificial arrays
4421
4422@cindex artificial array
4423@kindex @@
4424It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4425same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4426dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4427program.
4428
4429You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4430@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4431operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4432and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4433of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4434the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4435argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4436following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4437example. If a program says
4438
4439@example
4440int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4441@end example
4442
4443@noindent
4444you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4445
4446@example
4447p *array@@len
4448@end example
4449
4450The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4451with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4452subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4453Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4454(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4455
4456Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4457This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4458The value need not be in memory:
4459@example
4460(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4461$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4462@end example
4463
4464As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 4465@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c
SS
4466the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4467@example
4468(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4469$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4470@end example
4471
4472Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4473moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4474actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4475of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4476to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4477variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4478interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4479instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4480structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4481in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4482
4483@example
4484set $i = 0
4485p dtab[$i++]->fv
4486@key{RET}
4487@key{RET}
4488@dots{}
4489@end example
4490
53a5351d 4491@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4492@section Output formats
4493
4494@cindex formatted output
4495@cindex output formats
4496By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4497this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4498in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4499at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4500these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4501
4502The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4503already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4504@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4505letters supported are:
4506
4507@table @code
4508@item x
4509Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4510hexadecimal.
4511
4512@item d
4513Print as integer in signed decimal.
4514
4515@item u
4516Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4517
4518@item o
4519Print as integer in octal.
4520
4521@item t
4522Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4523@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4524used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4525see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4526
4527@item a
4528@cindex unknown address, locating
4529Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4530the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4531where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4532
4533@example
4534(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4535$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4536@end example
4537
4538@item c
4539Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4540
4541@item f
4542Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4543using typical floating point syntax.
4544@end table
4545
4546For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4547
4548@example
4549p/x $pc
4550@end example
4551
4552@noindent
4553Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4554names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4555
4556To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4557you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4558expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4559
53a5351d 4560@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4561@section Examining memory
4562
4563You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4564any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4565
4566@cindex examining memory
4567@table @code
4568@kindex x
4569@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4570@itemx x @var{addr}
4571@itemx x
4572Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4573@end table
4574
4575@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4576much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4577expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4578If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4579Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4580
4581@table @r
4582@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4583The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4584how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4585@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4586@c 4.1.2.
4587
4588@item @var{f}, the display format
4589The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4590@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4591The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4592The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4593
4594@item @var{u}, the unit size
4595The unit size is any of
4596
4597@table @code
4598@item b
4599Bytes.
4600@item h
4601Halfwords (two bytes).
4602@item w
4603Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4604@item g
4605Giant words (eight bytes).
4606@end table
4607
4608Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4609default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4610@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4611
4612@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4613@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4614memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4615it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4616@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4617@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4618other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4619the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4620starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4621a value from memory).
4622@end table
4623
4624For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4625(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4626starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4627words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4628@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4629
4630Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4631letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4632unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4633specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4634(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4635
4636Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4637and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4638@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4639including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4640alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4641Code,,Source and machine code}.
4642
4643All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4644easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4645you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4646instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4647with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4648the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4649for successive uses of @code{x}.
4650
4651@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4652The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4653in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4654would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4655subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4656@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4657examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4658@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4659the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4660
4661If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4662are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4663address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4664
53a5351d 4665@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4666@section Automatic display
4667@cindex automatic display
4668@cindex display of expressions
4669
4670If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4671(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4672display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4673Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4674to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4675The automatic display looks like this:
4676
4677@example
46782: foo = 38
46793: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4680@end example
4681
4682@noindent
4683This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4684displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4685specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4686whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4687format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4688or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4689supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4690
4691@table @code
4692@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
4693@item display @var{expr}
4694Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
4695each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4696
4697@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4698
d4f3574e 4699@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 4700For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 4701count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
4702arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4703@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4704
4705@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4706For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4707number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4708be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4709doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4710@end table
4711
4712For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4713instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 4714is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
4715
4716@table @code
4717@kindex delete display
4718@kindex undisplay
4719@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4720@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4721Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4722
4723@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4724(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4725
4726@kindex disable display
4727@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4728Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4729item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4730enabled again later.
4731
4732@kindex enable display
4733@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4734Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4735again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4736
4737@item display
4738Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4739done when your program stops.
4740
4741@kindex info display
4742@item info display
4743Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4744automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4745values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4746It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4747because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4748@end table
4749
4750If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4751sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
4752expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4753variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
4754@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
4755@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
4756continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
4757there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
4758automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
4759is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
4760
53a5351d 4761@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
4762@section Print settings
4763
4764@cindex format options
4765@cindex print settings
4766@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
4767and symbols are printed.
4768
4769@noindent
4770These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
4771
4772@table @code
4773@kindex set print address
4774@item set print address
4775@itemx set print address on
4776@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
4777traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
4778even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
4779is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
4780@code{set print address on}:
4781
4782@smallexample
4783@group
4784(@value{GDBP}) f
4785#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
4786 at input.c:530
4787530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4788@end group
4789@end smallexample
4790
4791@item set print address off
4792Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
4793this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
4794
4795@smallexample
4796@group
4797(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
4798(@value{GDBP}) f
4799#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
4800530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4801@end group
4802@end smallexample
4803
4804You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
4805dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
4806@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
4807all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
4808
4809@kindex show print address
4810@item show print address
4811Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
4812@end table
4813
4814When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
4815closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
4816identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
4817source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
4818@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
4819you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
4820it prints a symbolic address:
4821
4822@table @code
4823@kindex set print symbol-filename
4824@item set print symbol-filename on
4825Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
4826symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4827
4828@item set print symbol-filename off
4829Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
4830default.
4831
4832@kindex show print symbol-filename
4833@item show print symbol-filename
4834Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
4835line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4836@end table
4837
4838Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
4839numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
4840number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
4841
4842Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
4843printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
4844
4845@table @code
4846@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
4847@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
4848Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
4849offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
4850@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
4851to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
4852
4853@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
4854@item show print max-symbolic-offset
4855Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
4856symbolic address.
4857@end table
4858
4859@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
4860@cindex pointer, finding referent
4861If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
4862@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
4863and source file location of the variable where it points, using
4864@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
4865For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
4866at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
4867
4868@example
4869(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
4870(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
4871$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
4872@end example
4873
4874@quotation
4875@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
4876does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
4877the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
4878@end quotation
4879
4880Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
4881
4882@table @code
4883@kindex set print array
4884@item set print array
4885@itemx set print array on
4886Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
4887but uses more space. The default is off.
4888
4889@item set print array off
4890Return to compressed format for arrays.
4891
4892@kindex show print array
4893@item show print array
4894Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
4895arrays.
4896
4897@kindex set print elements
4898@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
4899Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
4900If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
4901printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
4902This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 4903When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
4904Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
4905
4906@kindex show print elements
4907@item show print elements
4908Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
4909If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
4910
4911@kindex set print null-stop
4912@item set print null-stop
4913Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 4914@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 4915contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 4916The default is off.
c906108c
SS
4917
4918@kindex set print pretty
4919@item set print pretty on
4920Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
4921per line, like this:
4922
4923@smallexample
4924@group
4925$1 = @{
4926 next = 0x0,
4927 flags = @{
4928 sweet = 1,
4929 sour = 1
4930 @},
4931 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
4932@}
4933@end group
4934@end smallexample
4935
4936@item set print pretty off
4937Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
4938
4939@smallexample
4940@group
4941$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
4942meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
4943@end group
4944@end smallexample
4945
4946@noindent
4947This is the default format.
4948
4949@kindex show print pretty
4950@item show print pretty
4951Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
4952
4953@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
4954@item set print sevenbit-strings on
4955Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
4956@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
4957character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
4958best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
4959high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
4960
4961@item set print sevenbit-strings off
4962Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
4963international character sets, and is the default.
4964
4965@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
4966@item show print sevenbit-strings
4967Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
4968
4969@kindex set print union
4970@item set print union on
4971Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
4972is the default setting.
4973
4974@item set print union off
4975Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
4976
4977@kindex show print union
4978@item show print union
4979Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
4980structures.
4981
4982For example, given the declarations
4983
4984@smallexample
4985typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
4986typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
4987typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
4988 Bug_forms;
4989
4990struct thing @{
4991 Species it;
4992 union @{
4993 Tree_forms tree;
4994 Bug_forms bug;
4995 @} form;
4996@};
4997
4998struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
4999@end smallexample
5000
5001@noindent
5002with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5003
5004@smallexample
5005$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5006@end smallexample
5007
5008@noindent
5009and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5010
5011@smallexample
5012$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5013@end smallexample
5014@end table
5015
c906108c
SS
5016@need 1000
5017@noindent
5018These settings are of interest when debugging C++ programs:
5019
5020@table @code
5021@cindex demangling
5022@kindex set print demangle
5023@item set print demangle
5024@itemx set print demangle on
5025Print C++ names in their source form rather than in the encoded
5026(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 5027linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5028
5029@kindex show print demangle
5030@item show print demangle
5031Show whether C++ names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
5032
5033@kindex set print asm-demangle
5034@item set print asm-demangle
5035@itemx set print asm-demangle on
5036Print C++ names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
5037in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5038The default is off.
5039
5040@kindex show print asm-demangle
5041@item show print asm-demangle
5042Show whether C++ names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
5043or demangled form.
5044
5045@kindex set demangle-style
5046@cindex C++ symbol decoding style
5047@cindex symbol decoding style, C++
5048@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5049Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
5050represent C++ names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
5051
5052@table @code
5053@item auto
5054Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5055
5056@item gnu
5057Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C++ compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 5058This is the default.
c906108c
SS
5059
5060@item hp
5061Decode based on the HP ANSI C++ (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
5062
5063@item lucid
5064Decode based on the Lucid C++ compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
5065
5066@item arm
5067Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C++ Annotated Reference Manual}.
5068@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5069debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5070require further enhancement to permit that.
5071
5072@end table
5073If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5074
5075@kindex show demangle-style
5076@item show demangle-style
5077Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C++ symbols.
5078
5079@kindex set print object
5080@item set print object
5081@itemx set print object on
5082When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5083(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5084the virtual function table.
5085
5086@item set print object off
5087Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5088virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5089
5090@kindex show print object
5091@item show print object
5092Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5093
5094@kindex set print static-members
5095@item set print static-members
5096@itemx set print static-members on
5097Print static members when displaying a C++ object. The default is on.
5098
5099@item set print static-members off
5100Do not print static members when displaying a C++ object.
5101
5102@kindex show print static-members
5103@item show print static-members
5104Show whether C++ static members are printed, or not.
5105
5106@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5107@kindex set print vtbl
5108@item set print vtbl
5109@itemx set print vtbl on
5110Pretty print C++ virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5111(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
5112ANSI C++ compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5113
5114@item set print vtbl off
5115Do not pretty print C++ virtual function tables.
5116
5117@kindex show print vtbl
5118@item show print vtbl
5119Show whether C++ virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
5120@end table
c906108c 5121
53a5351d 5122@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5123@section Value history
5124
5125@cindex value history
5126Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5127@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5128Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5129(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5130When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5131since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
5132symbol table.
5133
5134@cindex @code{$}
5135@cindex @code{$$}
5136@cindex history number
5137The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5138refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5139@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5140printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5141history number.
5142
5143To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5144history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5145remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5146the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5147@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5148is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5149@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5150
5151For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5152want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5153
5154@example
5155p *$
5156@end example
5157
5158If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5159to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5160
5161@example
5162p *$.next
5163@end example
5164
5165@noindent
5166You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5167command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5168
5169Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5170@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5171
5172@example
5173print x
5174set x=5
5175@end example
5176
5177@noindent
5178then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5179remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5180
5181@table @code
5182@kindex show values
5183@item show values
5184Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5185This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5186values} does not change the history.
5187
5188@item show values @var{n}
5189Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5190
5191@item show values +
5192Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5193values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5194@end table
5195
5196Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5197same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5198
53a5351d 5199@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5200@section Convenience variables
5201
5202@cindex convenience variables
5203@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5204@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5205exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5206setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5207of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5208
5209Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5210@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5211the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5212(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5213by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5214
5215You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5216expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5217For example:
5218
5219@example
5220set $foo = *object_ptr
5221@end example
5222
5223@noindent
5224would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5225@code{object_ptr}.
5226
5227Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5228value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5229value with another assignment at any time.
5230
5231Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5232variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5233that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5234variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5235
5236@table @code
5237@kindex show convenience
5238@item show convenience
5239Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5240Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5241@end table
5242
5243One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5244incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5245a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5246
5247@example
5248set $i = 0
5249print bar[$i++]->contents
5250@end example
5251
d4f3574e
SS
5252@noindent
5253Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5254
5255Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5256values likely to be useful.
5257
5258@table @code
5259@kindex $_
5260@item $_
5261The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5262the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5263commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5264set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5265and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5266except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5267to the type of @code{$__}.
5268
5269@kindex $__
5270@item $__
5271The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5272to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5273to match the format in which the data was printed.
5274
5275@item $_exitcode
5276@kindex $_exitcode
5277The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5278the program being debugged terminates.
5279@end table
5280
53a5351d
JM
5281On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5282begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5283name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5284
53a5351d 5285@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5286@section Registers
5287
5288@cindex registers
5289You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5290with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5291for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5292your machine.
5293
5294@table @code
5295@kindex info registers
5296@item info registers
5297Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5298registers (in the selected stack frame).
5299
5300@kindex info all-registers
5301@cindex floating point registers
5302@item info all-registers
5303Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5304registers.
5305
5306@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5307Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5308As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5309the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
5310the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5311@end table
5312
5313@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5314expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5315architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5316@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5317the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5318pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5319register that contains the processor status. For example,
5320you could print the program counter in hex with
5321
5322@example
5323p/x $pc
5324@end example
5325
5326@noindent
5327or print the instruction to be executed next with
5328
5329@example
5330x/i $pc
5331@end example
5332
5333@noindent
5334or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5335one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5336memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5337stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5338stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5339regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5340see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c
SS
5341
5342@example
5343set $sp += 4
5344@end example
5345
5346Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5347your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5348so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5349shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5350registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5351can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5352is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5353
5354@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5355integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5356special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5357registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5358to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5359(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5360@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5361
5362Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5363means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5364the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5365sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5366coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5367programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5368cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
5369that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5370prints the data in both formats.
5371
5372Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5373(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5374value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5375were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5376true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5377frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5378
5379However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5380code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5381@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5382frame makes no difference.
5383
53a5351d 5384@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5385@section Floating point hardware
5386@cindex floating point
5387
5388Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5389you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5390
5391@table @code
5392@kindex info float
5393@item info float
5394Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5395point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5396floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5397the ARM and x86 machines.
5398@end table
c906108c 5399
53a5351d 5400@node Languages
c906108c
SS
5401@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
5402@cindex languages
5403
c906108c
SS
5404Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
5405rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
5406dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
5407Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5408represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
5409@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
5410
5411@cindex working language
5412Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
5413allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
5414native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
5415consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
5416language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
5417language}.
5418
5419@menu
5420* Setting:: Switching between source languages
5421* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 5422* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
5423* Support:: Supported languages
5424@end menu
5425
53a5351d 5426@node Setting
c906108c
SS
5427@section Switching between source languages
5428
5429There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
5430set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
5431@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
5432defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
5433used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
5434are printed, etc.
5435
5436In addition to the working language, every source file that
5437@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
5438file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
5439source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
5440language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
5441controls whether C++ names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
5442show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
5443set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
5444set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
5445Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
5446
5447This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5448as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
5449another language. In that case, make the
5450program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
5451@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
5452program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
5453
5454@menu
5455* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
5456* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
5457* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
5458@end menu
5459
53a5351d 5460@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
5461@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
5462
5463If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
5464@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
5465
5466@table @file
5467
5468@item .c
5469C source file
5470
5471@item .C
5472@itemx .cc
5473@itemx .cp
5474@itemx .cpp
5475@itemx .cxx
5476@itemx .c++
5477C++ source file
5478
5479@item .f
5480@itemx .F
5481Fortran source file
5482
c906108c
SS
5483@item .ch
5484@itemx .c186
5485@itemx .c286
5486CHILL source file.
c906108c 5487
c906108c
SS
5488@item .mod
5489Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
5490
5491@item .s
5492@itemx .S
5493Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
5494@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
5495@end table
5496
5497In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
5498extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
5499
53a5351d 5500@node Manually
c906108c
SS
5501@subsection Setting the working language
5502
5503If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
5504expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
5505your program.
5506
5507@kindex set language
5508If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
5509command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5510a language, such as
c906108c 5511@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
5512For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
5513
c906108c
SS
5514Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
5515language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
5516to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
5517source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
5518languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
5519source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
5520command such as:
5521
5522@example
5523print a = b + c
5524@end example
5525
5526@noindent
5527might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
5528@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
5529printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
5530@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 5531
53a5351d 5532@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
5533@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
5534
5535To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
5536@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
5537then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
5538frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
5539working language to the language recorded for the function in that
5540frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
5541or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
5542does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
5543not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
5544
5545This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
5546entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
5547written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
5548a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
5549case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
5550
53a5351d 5551@node Show
c906108c 5552@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
5553
5554The following commands help you find out which language is the
5555working language, and also what language source files were written in.
5556
5557@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
5558@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
5559@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
5560@table @code
5561@item show language
5562Display the current working language. This is the
5563language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
5564build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
5565
5566@item info frame
5567Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
5568working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5569@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
5570information listed here.
5571
5572@item info source
5573Display the source language of this source file.
5574@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
5575information listed here.
5576@end table
5577
5578In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
5579not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
5580with a language explicitly:
5581
5582@kindex set extension-language
5583@kindex info extensions
5584@table @code
5585@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
5586Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
5587the source language @var{language}.
5588
5589@item info extensions
5590List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
5591@end table
5592
53a5351d 5593@node Checks
c906108c
SS
5594@section Type and range checking
5595
5596@quotation
5597@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
5598checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
5599section documents the intended facilities.
5600@end quotation
5601@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
5602
5603Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
5604errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
5605checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
5606sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
5607these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
5608by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
5609errors when your program is running.
5610
5611@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
5612Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
5613can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
5614the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
5615@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
5616your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
5617for the default settings of supported languages.
5618
5619@menu
5620* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
5621* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
5622@end menu
5623
5624@cindex type checking
5625@cindex checks, type
53a5351d 5626@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
5627@subsection An overview of type checking
5628
5629Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
5630arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
5631otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
5632errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
5633
5634@smallexample
56351 + 2 @result{} 3
5636@exdent but
5637@error{} 1 + 2.3
5638@end smallexample
5639
5640The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
5641type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
5642
5643For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
5644@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
5645to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
5646or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
5647but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
5648these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
5649also issues a warning.
5650
5651Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
5652related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
5653For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
5654a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
5655with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
5656the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
5657
5658Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
5659instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
5660operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
5661represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
5662operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
5663details on specific languages.
5664
5665@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
5666
d4f3574e 5667@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
5668@kindex set check type
5669@kindex show check type
5670@table @code
5671@item set check type auto
5672Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
5673@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
5674each language.
5675
5676@item set check type on
5677@itemx set check type off
5678Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
5679current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
5680match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 5681evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
5682message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
5683
5684@item set check type warn
5685Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
5686evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
5687be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
5688numbers and structures.
5689
5690@item show type
5691Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
5692is setting it automatically.
5693@end table
5694
5695@cindex range checking
5696@cindex checks, range
53a5351d 5697@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
5698@subsection An overview of range checking
5699
5700In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
5701bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
5702checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
5703computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
5704not exceed the bounds of the array.
5705
5706For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
5707@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
5708always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
5709warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
5710
5711A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
5712array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
5713of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
5714error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
5715result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
5716the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
5717
5718@example
5719@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
5720@end example
5721
5722This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
5723specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
5724Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
5725
5726@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
5727
d4f3574e 5728@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
5729@kindex set check range
5730@kindex show check range
5731@table @code
5732@item set check range auto
5733Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
5734@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
5735each language.
5736
5737@item set check range on
5738@itemx set check range off
5739Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
5740current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
5741match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
5742then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
5743
5744@item set check range warn
5745Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
5746but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
5747expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
5748memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
5749systems).
5750
5751@item show range
5752Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
5753being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
5754@end table
c906108c 5755
53a5351d 5756@node Support
c906108c 5757@section Supported languages
c906108c 5758
cce74817
JM
5759@value{GDBN} supports C, C++, Fortran, Java, Chill, assembly, and Modula-2.
5760@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
5761Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
5762language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
5763and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
5764,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
5765language.
5766
5767The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
5768supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
5769tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
5770@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
5771formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
5772books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
5773language reference or tutorial.
5774
c906108c 5775@menu
7a292a7a 5776* C:: C and C++
cce74817 5777* Modula-2:: Modula-2
104c1213 5778* Chill:: Chill
c906108c
SS
5779@end menu
5780
53a5351d 5781@node C
c906108c 5782@subsection C and C++
7a292a7a 5783
c906108c
SS
5784@cindex C and C++
5785@cindex expressions in C or C++
c906108c
SS
5786
5787Since C and C++ are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
5788to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
5789together.
5790
c906108c
SS
5791@cindex C++
5792@kindex g++
5793@cindex @sc{gnu} C++
5794The C++ debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C++
5795compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C++ code
5796effectively, you must compile your C++ programs with a supported
5797C++ compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C++
5798compiler (@code{aCC}).
5799
5800For best results when using @sc{gnu} C++, use the stabs debugging
5801format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
5802command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
5803@ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
5804CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
c906108c 5805
c906108c
SS
5806@menu
5807* C Operators:: C and C++ operators
5808* C Constants:: C and C++ constants
7a292a7a 5809* C plus plus expressions:: C++ expressions
c906108c 5810* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C++
c906108c 5811* C Checks:: C and C++ type and range checks
c906108c
SS
5812* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
5813* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C++
5814@end menu
c906108c 5815
53a5351d 5816@node C Operators
c906108c 5817@subsubsection C and C++ operators
7a292a7a
SS
5818
5819@cindex C and C++ operators
c906108c
SS
5820
5821Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
5822@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5823often defined on groups of types.
5824
c906108c 5825For the purposes of C and C++, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
5826
5827@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 5828
c906108c 5829@item
c906108c
SS
5830@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
5831specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C++, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
5832
5833@item
d4f3574e
SS
5834@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
5835@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
5836
5837@item
53a5351d 5838@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
5839
5840@item
5841@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 5842
c906108c
SS
5843@end itemize
5844
5845@noindent
5846The following operators are supported. They are listed here
5847in order of increasing precedence:
5848
5849@table @code
5850@item ,
5851The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
5852are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
5853expression being the last expression evaluated.
5854
5855@item =
5856Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
5857assigned. Defined on scalar types.
5858
5859@item @var{op}=
5860Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
5861and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 5862@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
5863@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
5864@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
5865
5866@item ?:
5867The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
5868of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
5869integral type.
5870
5871@item ||
5872Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5873
5874@item &&
5875Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
5876
5877@item |
5878Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5879
5880@item ^
5881Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5882
5883@item &
5884Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
5885
5886@item ==@r{, }!=
5887Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
5888expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
5889
5890@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
5891Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
5892Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
5893and non-zero for true.
5894
5895@item <<@r{, }>>
5896left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
5897
5898@item @@
5899The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
5900
5901@item +@r{, }-
5902Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
5903pointer types.
5904
5905@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
5906Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
5907defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
5908integral types.
5909
5910@item ++@r{, }--
5911Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
5912operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
5913when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
5914operation takes place.
5915
5916@item *
5917Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
5918@code{++}.
5919
5920@item &
5921Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
5922
c906108c
SS
5923For debugging C++, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
5924allowed in the C++ language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
5925(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
5926where a C++ reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
5927stored.
c906108c
SS
5928
5929@item -
5930Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
5931precedence as @code{++}.
5932
5933@item !
5934Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
5935@code{++}.
5936
5937@item ~
5938Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
5939@code{++}.
5940
5941
5942@item .@r{, }->
5943Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
5944@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
5945pointer based on the stored type information.
5946Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
5947
c906108c
SS
5948@item .*@r{, }->*
5949Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
5950
5951@item []
5952Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
5953@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
5954
5955@item ()
5956Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
5957
c906108c 5958@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
5959C++ scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
5960and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
5961
5962@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
5963Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
5964(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
5965above.
c906108c
SS
5966@end table
5967
c906108c
SS
5968If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
5969attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
5970predefined meaning.
c906108c 5971
c906108c
SS
5972@menu
5973* C Constants::
5974@end menu
5975
53a5351d 5976@node C Constants
c906108c 5977@subsubsection C and C++ constants
c906108c
SS
5978
5979@cindex C and C++ constants
c906108c 5980
7a292a7a 5981@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C++ in the
c906108c 5982following ways:
c906108c
SS
5983
5984@itemize @bullet
5985@item
5986Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
5987specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e. zero), and hexadecimal constants by
5988a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
5989@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
5990@code{long} value.
5991
5992@item
5993Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
5994point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
5995exponent. An exponent is of the form:
5996@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
5997sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
5998A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
5999@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
6000the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
6001a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
6002constant.
c906108c
SS
6003
6004@item
6005Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
6006integral equivalents.
6007
6008@item
6009Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
6010(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 6011(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
6012be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
6013the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
6014of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
6015@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
6016@samp{\n} for newline.
6017
6018@item
6019String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded
6020by double quotes (@code{"}).
6021
6022@item
6023Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
6024to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
6025
6026@item
6027Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
6028and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
6029integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
6030and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
6031@end itemize
6032
c906108c 6033@menu
7a292a7a 6034* C plus plus expressions::
c906108c 6035* C Defaults::
c906108c 6036* C Checks::
c906108c
SS
6037
6038* Debugging C::
6039@end menu
6040
53a5351d 6041@node C plus plus expressions
c906108c 6042@subsubsection C++ expressions
c906108c
SS
6043
6044@cindex expressions in C++
6045@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C++ expressions.
6046
c906108c
SS
6047@cindex C++ support, not in @sc{coff}
6048@cindex @sc{coff} versus C++
6049@cindex C++ and object formats
6050@cindex object formats and C++
6051@cindex a.out and C++
6052@cindex @sc{ecoff} and C++
6053@cindex @sc{xcoff} and C++
6054@cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C++
6055@cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C++
6056@c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
6057@c periodically whether this has happened...
6058@quotation
6059@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C++ code if you use the
6060proper compiler. Typically, C++ debugging depends on the use of
6061additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
6062special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
6063@sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
6064symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
6065you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
6066extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
6067@sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C++
6068support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
6069@end quotation
c906108c
SS
6070
6071@enumerate
6072
6073@cindex member functions
6074@item
6075Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
6076
6077@example
6078count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
6079@end example
6080
6081@kindex this
6082@cindex namespace in C++
6083@item
6084While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
6085expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
6086that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
6087pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C++.
6088
c906108c 6089@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 6090@cindex overloaded functions, calling
c906108c
SS
6091@cindex type conversions in C++
6092@item
6093You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 6094call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
6095perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
6096calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
6097in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
6098default arguments.
6099
6100It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
6101promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
6102class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
6103functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
6104number of function arguments.
6105
6106Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
6107@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
6108,@value{GDBN} features for C++}.
6109
d4f3574e 6110You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
6111explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
6112@smallexample
6113p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
6114@end smallexample
d4f3574e 6115
c906108c 6116The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 6117see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 6118
c906108c
SS
6119@cindex reference declarations
6120@item
6121@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C++ references; you can use
6122them in expressions just as you do in C++ source---they are automatically
6123dereferenced.
6124
6125In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
6126reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
6127avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
6128The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
6129you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
6130
6131@item
6132@value{GDBN} supports the C++ name resolution operator @code{::}---your
6133expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
6134one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
6135necessary, for example in an expression like
6136@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
6137resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C++
6138debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
6139@end enumerate
6140
53a5351d
JM
6141In addition, when used with HP's C++ compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
6142calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
6143objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
6144invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 6145
53a5351d 6146@node C Defaults
c906108c 6147@subsubsection C and C++ defaults
7a292a7a 6148
c906108c
SS
6149@cindex C and C++ defaults
6150
c906108c
SS
6151If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
6152both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
6153C or C++. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
6154selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
6155
6156If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
6157recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
6158@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
6159these files, it sets the working language to C or C++.
6160@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
6161for further details.
6162
c906108c
SS
6163@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
6164@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
6165@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 6166
53a5351d 6167@node C Checks
c906108c 6168@subsubsection C and C++ type and range checks
7a292a7a 6169
c906108c
SS
6170@cindex C and C++ checks
6171
6172By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C++ expressions, type checking
6173is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
6174considers two variables type equivalent if:
6175
6176@itemize @bullet
6177@item
6178The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
6179enumerated tag.
6180
6181@item
6182The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
6183declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
6184
6185@ignore
6186@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
6187@c FIXME--beers?
6188@item
6189The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
6190declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
6191compilers.)
6192@end ignore
6193@end itemize
6194
6195Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
6196indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
6197that is not itself an array.
c906108c 6198
53a5351d 6199@node Debugging C
c906108c 6200@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
6201
6202The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
6203the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
6204inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
6205appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
6206
6207The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
6208with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
6209,Expressions}.
6210
c906108c
SS
6211@menu
6212* Debugging C plus plus::
6213@end menu
6214
53a5351d 6215@node Debugging C plus plus
c906108c 6216@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C++
c906108c
SS
6217
6218@cindex commands for C++
7a292a7a 6219
c906108c
SS
6220Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C++, and some are
6221designed specifically for use with C++. Here is a summary:
6222
6223@table @code
6224@cindex break in overloaded functions
6225@item @r{breakpoint menus}
6226When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
6227@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
6228you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
6229
6230@cindex overloading in C++
6231@item rbreak @var{regex}
6232Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
6233breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
6234classes.
6235@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
6236
6237@cindex C++ exception handling
6238@item catch throw
6239@itemx catch catch
6240Debug C++ exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
6241Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
6242
6243@cindex inheritance
6244@item ptype @var{typename}
6245Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
6246@var{typename}.
6247@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
6248
6249@cindex C++ symbol display
6250@item set print demangle
6251@itemx show print demangle
6252@itemx set print asm-demangle
6253@itemx show print asm-demangle
6254Control whether C++ symbols display in their source form, both when
6255displaying code as C++ source and when displaying disassemblies.
6256@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6257
6258@item set print object
6259@itemx show print object
6260Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
6261@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6262
6263@item set print vtbl
6264@itemx show print vtbl
6265Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
6266@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c
SS
6267(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6268ANSI C++ compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6269
6270@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 6271@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c
SS
6272@item set overload-resolution on
6273Enable overload resolution for C++ expression evaluation. The default
6274is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
6275and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
d4f3574e
SS
6276using the standard C++ conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C++
6277expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
6278message.
6279
6280@item set overload-resolution off
6281Disable overload resolution for C++ expression evaluation. For
6282overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
6283chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
6284symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
6285overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
6286searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
6287argument types.
c906108c
SS
6288
6289@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
6290You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
6291the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C++: type
6292@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
6293also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
6294available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
6295@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
6296@end table
c906108c 6297
53a5351d 6298@node Modula-2
c906108c 6299@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 6300
d4f3574e 6301@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
6302
6303The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
6304output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
6305developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
6306attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
6307to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
6308table.
6309
6310@cindex expressions in Modula-2
6311@menu
6312* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
6313* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
6314* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
6315* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
6316* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
6317* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
6318* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
6319* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
6320@end menu
6321
53a5351d 6322@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
6323@subsubsection Operators
6324@cindex Modula-2 operators
6325
6326Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
6327@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
6328often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
6329following definitions hold:
6330
6331@itemize @bullet
6332
6333@item
6334@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
6335their subranges.
6336
6337@item
6338@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
6339
6340@item
6341@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
6342
6343@item
6344@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
6345@var{type}}.
6346
6347@item
6348@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
6349
6350@item
6351@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
6352
6353@item
6354@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
6355@end itemize
6356
6357@noindent
6358The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
6359increasing precedence:
6360
6361@table @code
6362@item ,
6363Function argument or array index separator.
6364
6365@item :=
6366Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
6367@var{value}.
6368
6369@item <@r{, }>
6370Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
6371types.
6372
6373@item <=@r{, }>=
6374Less than, greater than, less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
6375on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
6376set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
6377
6378@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
6379Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
6380Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
6381available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
6382comment character.
6383
6384@item IN
6385Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
6386Same precedence as @code{<}.
6387
6388@item OR
6389Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
6390
6391@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 6392Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
6393
6394@item @@
6395The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
6396
6397@item +@r{, }-
6398Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
6399and difference on set types.
6400
6401@item *
6402Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
6403on set types.
6404
6405@item /
6406Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
6407types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
6408
6409@item DIV@r{, }MOD
6410Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
6411precedence as @code{*}.
6412
6413@item -
6414Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
6415
6416@item ^
6417Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
6418
6419@item NOT
6420Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
6421@code{^}.
6422
6423@item .
6424@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
6425precedence as @code{^}.
6426
6427@item []
6428Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
6429
6430@item ()
6431Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
6432as @code{^}.
6433
6434@item ::@r{, }.
6435@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
6436@end table
6437
6438@quotation
6439@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
6440treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
6441@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
6442@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
6443@end quotation
6444
6445@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
53a5351d 6446@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c
SS
6447@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
6448
6449Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
6450In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
6451
6452@table @var
6453
6454@item a
6455represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
6456
6457@item c
6458represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
6459
6460@item i
6461represents a variable or constant of integral type.
6462
6463@item m
6464represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
6465same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
6466be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
6467
6468@item n
6469represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
6470
6471@item r
6472represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
6473
6474@item t
6475represents a type.
6476
6477@item v
6478represents a variable.
6479
6480@item x
6481represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
6482explanation of the function for details.
6483@end table
6484
6485All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
6486
6487@table @code
6488@item ABS(@var{n})
6489Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
6490
6491@item CAP(@var{c})
6492If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 6493equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
6494
6495@item CHR(@var{i})
6496Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
6497
6498@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 6499Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
6500
6501@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
6502Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
6503new value.
6504
6505@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
6506Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
6507set.
6508
6509@item FLOAT(@var{i})
6510Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
6511
6512@item HIGH(@var{a})
6513Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
6514
6515@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 6516Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
6517
6518@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
6519Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
6520new value.
6521
6522@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
6523Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
6524there. Returns the new set.
6525
6526@item MAX(@var{t})
6527Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
6528
6529@item MIN(@var{t})
6530Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
6531
6532@item ODD(@var{i})
6533Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
6534
6535@item ORD(@var{x})
6536Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
6537value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
6538@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
6539integral, character and enumerated types.
6540
6541@item SIZE(@var{x})
6542Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
6543
6544@item TRUNC(@var{r})
6545Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
6546
6547@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
6548Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
6549@end table
6550
6551@quotation
6552@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
6553@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
6554an error.
6555@end quotation
6556
6557@cindex Modula-2 constants
53a5351d 6558@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
6559@subsubsection Constants
6560
6561@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
6562ways:
6563
6564@itemize @bullet
6565
6566@item
6567Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
6568expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
6569rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
6570trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
6571
6572@item
6573Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
6574decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
6575then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
6576@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
6577digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
6578digits.
6579
6580@item
6581Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
6582like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 6583also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
6584followed by a @samp{C}.
6585
6586@item
6587String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
6588pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
6589Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
6590Constants, ,C and C++ constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
6591sequences.
6592
6593@item
6594Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
6595
6596@item
6597Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
6598@code{FALSE}.
6599
6600@item
6601Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
6602
6603@item
6604Set constants are not yet supported.
6605@end itemize
6606
53a5351d 6607@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
6608@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
6609@cindex Modula-2 defaults
6610
6611If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
6612both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 6613Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
6614selected the working language.
6615
6616If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
6617code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 6618working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
6619the language automatically}, for further details.
6620
53a5351d 6621@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
6622@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
6623@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
6624
6625A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
6626This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
6627
6628@itemize @bullet
6629@item
6630Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
6631integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
6632debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
6633pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
6634through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
6635returned a pointer.)
6636
6637@item
6638C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
6639non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
6640escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
6641printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
6642
6643@item
6644The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
6645argument.
6646
6647@item
6648All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
6649@end itemize
6650
53a5351d 6651@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
6652@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
6653@cindex Modula-2 checks
6654
6655@quotation
6656@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
6657range checking.
6658@end quotation
6659@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
6660
6661@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
6662
6663@itemize @bullet
6664@item
6665They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
6666@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
6667
6668@item
6669They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
6670@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
6671@end itemize
6672
6673As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
6674whose types are not equivalent is an error.
6675
6676Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
6677index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
6678
53a5351d 6679@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
6680@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
6681@cindex scope
6682@kindex .
6683@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
6684@ifinfo
d4f3574e 6685@kindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
6686@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
6687@end ifinfo
6688@iftex
6689@kindex ::
6690@end iftex
6691
6692There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
6693(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
6694similar syntax:
6695
6696@example
6697
6698@var{module} . @var{id}
6699@var{scope} :: @var{id}
6700@end example
6701
6702@noindent
6703where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
6704@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
6705identifier within your program, except another module.
6706
6707Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
6708specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
6709found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
6710enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
6711
6712Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
6713the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
6714definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
6715an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
6716module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
6717@var{module}.
6718
53a5351d 6719@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
6720@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
6721
6722Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
6723Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
6724specifically to C and C++: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
6725@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
6726apply to C++, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
6727analogue in Modula-2.
6728
6729The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 6730with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c
SS
6731intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
6732created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C++. However, because an
6733address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 6734@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
6735
6736@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
6737In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
6738interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 6739
53a5351d 6740@node Chill
cce74817
JM
6741@subsection Chill
6742
6743The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
d4f3574e 6744from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
cce74817
JM
6745supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
6746likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
6747table.
6748
d4f3574e
SS
6749@c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
6750@c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
6751This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
cce74817
JM
6752of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
6753
6754@menu
104c1213
JM
6755* How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
6756* Locations:: Locations and their accesses
cce74817 6757* Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
53a5351d
JM
6758* Chill type and range checks::
6759* Chill defaults::
cce74817
JM
6760@end menu
6761
6762@node How modes are displayed
6763@subsubsection How modes are displayed
6764
6765The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
d4f3574e 6766with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
cce74817
JM
6767slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
6768provided modes are:
d4f3574e
SS
6769
6770@c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
6771@c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
cce74817
JM
6772@table @code
6773@item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
6774@itemize @bullet
6775@item
6776@emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
6777UINT, LONG, ULONG},
6778@item
6779@emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
6780@item
6781@emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
6782@item
6783@emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
6784@smallexample
6785(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6786type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
6787@end smallexample
6788If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
6789@item
6790@emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by @code{type = <basemode>
6791(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}, where @code{<lower bound>, <upper
6792bound>} can be of any discrete literal expression (e.g. set element
6793names).
6794@end itemize
6795
6796@item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
6797A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
d4f3574e 6798the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
cce74817
JM
6799@smallexample
6800(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6801type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
6802@end smallexample
6803
6804@item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
6805@itemize @bullet
6806@item
d4f3574e 6807@emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
cce74817
JM
6808followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
6809@item
6810@emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
6811@end itemize
6812
6813@item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
6814The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
6815<return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
d4f3574e
SS
6816list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
6817the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
cce74817
JM
6818all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
6819
6820@ignore
6821@item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
6822The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
6823type, and is therefore not really of interest.
6824@end ignore
6825
6826@item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
6827@itemize @bullet
6828@item
6829@emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by @code{EVENT (<event length>)},
6830where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
6831@item
6832@emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by @code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)
6833<buffer element mode>}, where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
6834@end itemize
6835
6836@item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
6837@itemize @bullet
6838@item
6839@emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
6840@item
6841@emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
6842@end itemize
6843
6844@item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
6845Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
6846
6847@item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
6848@itemize @bullet
6849@item
6850@emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by @code{CHARS(<string
6851length>)}, followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is
6852a varying mode
6853@item
6854@emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by @code{BOOLS(<string
6855length>)}.
6856@end itemize
6857
6858@item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
6859The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
6860followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
6861@smallexample
6862(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6863type = ARRAY (1:42)
6864 ARRAY (1:20)
6865 SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
6866@end smallexample
6867
6868@item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
6869The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
d4f3574e
SS
6870list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
6871of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
6872OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
cce74817
JM
6873of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
6874checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
6875always displays all variant fields.
6876@smallexample
6877(@value{GDBP}) ptype str
6878type = STRUCT (
6879 as x,
6880 bs x,
6881 CASE bs OF
6882 (karli):
6883 cs a
6884 (ott):
6885 ds x
6886 ESAC
6887)
6888@end smallexample
6889@end table
6890
6891@node Locations
6892@subsubsection Locations and their accesses
6893
6894A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
6895
6896A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
d4f3574e
SS
6897the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
6898Chill programs. How values are specified
6899is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
6900
6901The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
6902display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
d4f3574e 6903
cce74817
JM
6904@smallexample
6905set result := EXPR
6906@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
6907
6908@noindent
6909This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
c3f6f71d 6910is not available in @value{GDBN}).
cce74817
JM
6911
6912Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
6913value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
d4f3574e 6914mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
cce74817
JM
6915represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
6916value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
d4f3574e 6917operator @samp{->}.
cce74817
JM
6918
6919Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by @code{@{ PROC
6920(<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
d4f3574e 6921location>}. @code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the
cce74817
JM
6922parameter specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the
6923address of the entry point.
6924
6925@ignore
6926Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
6927fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
6928the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
d4f3574e
SS
6929implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
6930na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
6931<instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
cce74817
JM
6932@code{__proc_copy}.
6933
6934Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
6935the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
6936like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
6937mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
6938
6939Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
d4f3574e 6940...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
cce74817 6941definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
d4f3574e
SS
6942of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
6943structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
6944braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
cce74817 6945on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
d4f3574e 6946memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
cce74817 6947all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
d4f3574e 6948@code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
cce74817
JM
6949stuff ???)
6950@smallexample
6951(@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
6952[.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
6953@end smallexample
6954@end ignore
6955
6956Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
6957(e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
d4f3574e
SS
6958certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
6959and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
6960
6961A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
d4f3574e
SS
6962location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
6963name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
6964have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
6965checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
cce74817 6966therefore the result can be quite confusing.
d4f3574e 6967
cce74817
JM
6968@smallexample
6969(@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
6970@end smallexample
6971
6972@node Values and their Operations
6973@subsubsection Values and their Operations
6974
6975Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
6976more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
d4f3574e
SS
6977data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
6978such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
cce74817 6979constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
d4f3574e 6980when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
cce74817
JM
6981(e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
6982the values behind these locations.
6983
d4f3574e 6984This section describes how values have to be specified and which
cce74817
JM
6985operations are legal to be used with such values.
6986
6987@table @code
6988@item Literal Values
d4f3574e
SS
6989Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
6990For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
cce74817 6991chapter 1.5.
d4f3574e
SS
6992@c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
6993@c be converted to a @ref.
cce74817
JM
6994
6995@ignore
6996@itemize @bullet
6997@item
6998@emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
d4f3574e 6999programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
cce74817
JM
7000@item
7001@emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
7002@item
7003@emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
7004@code{'M'})
7005@item
7006@emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
d4f3574e
SS
7007mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
7008comparable to an enumeration in C/C++ language.
cce74817 7009@item
d4f3574e 7010@emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
cce74817
JM
7011emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
7012procedure value or the empty instance value.
7013
7014@item
7015@emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
d4f3574e 7016enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
cce74817
JM
7017to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
7018@item
7019@emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
7020programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
7021@item
7022@emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
d4f3574e 7023(gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
cce74817
JM
7024@end itemize
7025@end ignore
7026
7027@item Tuple Values
7028A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
d4f3574e 7029name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
cce74817
JM
7030unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
7031@code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
d4f3574e 7032
cce74817
JM
7033@itemize @bullet
7034@item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
7035@item @emph{Array Tuple}
7036@item @emph{Structure Tuple}
7037Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
d4f3574e 7038same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
cce74817
JM
7039@end itemize
7040
7041@item String Element Value
7042A string element value is specified by @code{<string value>(<index>)},
d4f3574e 7043where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
cce74817
JM
7044value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
7045the string.
7046
7047@item String Slice Value
7048A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
7049spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
7050expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
7051@code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
7052The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
7053string.
7054
7055@item Array Element Values
7056An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
7057delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
7058
7059@item Array Slice Values
7060An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
7061@code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
d4f3574e
SS
7062@code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
7063arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
cce74817
JM
7064which is part of the specified array.
7065
7066@item Structure Field Values
7067A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
d4f3574e
SS
7068name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
7069in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
cce74817
JM
7070corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
7071
7072@item Procedure Call Value
7073The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
7074procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
7075expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
d4f3574e 7076effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
cce74817 7077
d4f3574e 7078Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
cce74817 7079
d4f3574e 7080Values of time mode locations are represented by @code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}.
cce74817
JM
7081
7082@ignore
7083This is not implemented yet:
7084@item Built-in Value
7085@noindent
7086The following built in functions are provided:
d4f3574e 7087
cce74817
JM
7088@table @code
7089@item @code{ADDR()}
7090@item @code{NUM()}
7091@item @code{PRED()}
7092@item @code{SUCC()}
7093@item @code{ABS()}
7094@item @code{CARD()}
7095@item @code{MAX()}
7096@item @code{MIN()}
7097@item @code{SIZE()}
7098@item @code{UPPER()}
7099@item @code{LOWER()}
7100@item @code{LENGTH()}
7101@item @code{SIN()}
7102@item @code{COS()}
7103@item @code{TAN()}
7104@item @code{ARCSIN()}
7105@item @code{ARCCOS()}
7106@item @code{ARCTAN()}
7107@item @code{EXP()}
7108@item @code{LN()}
7109@item @code{LOG()}
7110@item @code{SQRT()}
7111@end table
7112
7113For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
7114chapter 1.6.
7115@end ignore
7116
7117@item Zero-adic Operator Value
7118The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
7119current active process.
7120
7121@item Expression Values
7122The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
d4f3574e 7123the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
cce74817 7124incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
d4f3574e 7125corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
cce74817 7126causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
d4f3574e 7127which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
cce74817 7128operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
d4f3574e 7129
cce74817
JM
7130@table @code
7131@item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
7132@itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
7133@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 7134Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
d4f3574e 7135
cce74817
JM
7136@item @code{=, /=}
7137Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
d4f3574e 7138
cce74817 7139@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 7140@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 7141Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 7142
cce74817 7143@item @code{+, -}
d4f3574e 7144@itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
cce74817 7145Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 7146
cce74817
JM
7147@item @code{-}
7148Change sign operator.
d4f3574e 7149
cce74817
JM
7150@item @code{//}
7151String concatenation operator.
d4f3574e 7152
cce74817
JM
7153@item @code{()}
7154String repetition operator.
d4f3574e 7155
cce74817
JM
7156@item @code{->}
7157Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
7158address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
7159location (@code{loc->}).
d4f3574e 7160
cce74817 7161@item @code{OR, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
7162@itemx @code{AND}
7163@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 7164Powerset and bitstring operators.
d4f3574e 7165
cce74817 7166@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 7167@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 7168Powerset inclusion operators.
d4f3574e 7169
cce74817
JM
7170@item @code{IN}
7171Membership operator.
7172@end table
7173@end table
7174
53a5351d 7175@node Chill type and range checks
cce74817
JM
7176@subsubsection Chill type and range checks
7177
7178@value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
d4f3574e 7179of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
cce74817 7180complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
d4f3574e 7181equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
cce74817
JM
7182structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
7183
7184Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
7185index bounds and all built in procedures.
7186
7187Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
d4f3574e 7188check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
cce74817
JM
7189operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
7190functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
7191language specification.
7192
cce74817
JM
7193All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
7194off}.
7195
7196@ignore
53a5351d 7197@c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
cce74817
JM
7198see last paragraph ?
7199@end ignore
7200
53a5351d 7201@node Chill defaults
cce74817
JM
7202@subsubsection Chill defaults
7203
7204If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
7205both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 7206Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
cce74817
JM
7207selected the working language.
7208
7209If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
7210code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
d4f3574e 7211working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
cce74817
JM
7212the language automatically}, for further details.
7213
53a5351d 7214@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
7215@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
7216
d4f3574e 7217The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
7218symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
7219program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
7220does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
7221program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
7222(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
7223file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
7224
7225@cindex symbol names
7226@cindex names of symbols
7227@cindex quoting names
7228Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
7229characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
7230most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
7231source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
7232are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
7233ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
7234@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
7235@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
7236
7237@example
7238p 'foo.c'::x
7239@end example
7240
7241@noindent
7242looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
7243
7244@table @code
7245@kindex info address
7246@item info address @var{symbol}
7247Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
7248variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
7249local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
7250is always stored.
7251
7252Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
7253at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
7254the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
7255
7256@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
7257@item whatis @var{expr}
7258Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
7259actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
7260assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
7261@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
7262
7263@item whatis
7264Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
7265
7266@kindex ptype
7267@item ptype @var{typename}
7268Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
7269the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
7270@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
7271@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 7272
d4f3574e 7273@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 7274@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 7275Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
7276differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
7277of just the name of the type.
7278
7279For example, for this variable declaration:
7280
7281@example
7282struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
7283@end example
7284
7285@noindent
7286the two commands give this output:
7287
7288@example
7289@group
7290(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
7291type = struct complex
7292(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
7293type = struct complex @{
7294 double real;
7295 double imag;
7296@}
7297@end group
7298@end example
7299
7300@noindent
7301As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
7302the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
7303
7304@kindex info types
7305@item info types @var{regexp}
7306@itemx info types
d4f3574e 7307Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
7308(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
7309complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
7310@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 7311names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
7312information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
7313
7314This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
7315@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
7316lists all source files where a type is defined.
7317
7318@kindex info source
7319@item info source
7320Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for
7321the function containing the current point of execution---and the language
7322it was written in.
7323
7324@kindex info sources
7325@item info sources
7326Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
7327debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
7328have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
7329
7330@kindex info functions
7331@item info functions
7332Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
7333
7334@item info functions @var{regexp}
7335Print the names and data types of all defined functions
7336whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
7337Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
7338include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
7339start with @code{step}.
7340
7341@kindex info variables
7342@item info variables
7343Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
7344outside of functions (i.e., excluding local variables).
7345
7346@item info variables @var{regexp}
7347Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
7348variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
7349@var{regexp}.
7350
7351@ignore
7352This was never implemented.
7353@kindex info methods
7354@item info methods
7355@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
7356The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
7357methods within C++ program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
7358specific set of methods found in the various C++ classes. Many
7359C++ classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
7360from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
7361@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
7362which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
7363@end ignore
7364
c906108c
SS
7365@cindex reloading symbols
7366Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
7367be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
7368in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
7369running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
7370@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
7371
7372@table @code
7373@kindex set symbol-reloading
7374@item set symbol-reloading on
7375Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
7376object file with a particular name is seen again.
7377
7378@item set symbol-reloading off
7379Do not replace symbol definitions when re-encountering object files of
7380the same name. This is the default state; if you are not running on a
7381system that permits automatically relinking modules, you should leave
7382@code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN} may discard symbols
7383when linking large programs, that may contain several modules (from
7384different directories or libraries) with the same name.
7385
7386@kindex show symbol-reloading
7387@item show symbol-reloading
7388Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
7389@end table
c906108c 7390
c906108c
SS
7391@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
7392@item set opaque-type-resolution on
7393Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
7394declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
7395@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
7396source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
7397another source file. The default is on.
7398
7399A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
7400the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
7401
7402@item set opaque-type-resolution off
7403Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
7404is printed as follows:
7405@smallexample
7406@{<no data fields>@}
7407@end smallexample
7408
7409@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
7410@item show opaque-type-resolution
7411Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
7412
7413@kindex maint print symbols
7414@cindex symbol dump
7415@kindex maint print psymbols
7416@cindex partial symbol dump
7417@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
7418@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
7419@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
7420Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
7421These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
7422symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
7423symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
7424collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
7425only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
7426command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
7427use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
7428symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
7429files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
7430@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
7431required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
7432@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
7433@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
7434@end table
7435
53a5351d 7436@node Altering
c906108c
SS
7437@chapter Altering Execution
7438
7439Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
7440find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
7441correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
7442experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
7443program.
7444
7445For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
7446locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
7447address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
7448
7449@menu
7450* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
7451* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 7452* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
7453* Returning:: Returning from a function
7454* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
7455* Patching:: Patching your program
7456@end menu
7457
53a5351d 7458@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
7459@section Assignment to variables
7460
7461@cindex assignment
7462@cindex setting variables
7463To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
7464@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
7465
7466@example
7467print x=4
7468@end example
7469
7470@noindent
7471stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
7472value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
7473@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
7474information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
7475
7476@kindex set variable
7477@cindex variables, setting
7478If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
7479@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
7480really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
7481not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
7482,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
7483
c906108c
SS
7484If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
7485appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
7486variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
7487to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
7488program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
7489a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
7490command @code{set width}:
7491
7492@example
7493(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
7494type = double
7495(@value{GDBP}) p width
7496$4 = 13
7497(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
7498Invalid syntax in expression.
7499@end example
7500
7501@noindent
7502The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
7503order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
7504
7505@example
7506(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
7507@end example
53a5351d 7508
c906108c
SS
7509Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
7510with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
7511@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
7512your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
7513to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
7514the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
7515
7516@example
7517@group
7518(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
7519type = double
7520(@value{GDBP}) p g
7521$1 = 1
7522(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 7523(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
7524$2 = 1
7525(@value{GDBP}) r
7526The program being debugged has been started already.
7527Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
7528Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
7529"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols: Invalid bfd target.
7530(@value{GDBP}) show g
7531The current BFD target is "=4".
7532@end group
7533@end example
7534
7535@noindent
7536The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
7537@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
7538@code{g}, use
7539
7540@example
7541(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
7542@end example
c906108c
SS
7543
7544@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
7545freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
7546and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
7547same length or shorter.
7548@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
7549@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
7550
7551To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
7552construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
7553(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
7554to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
7555and representation in memory), and
7556
7557@example
7558set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
7559@end example
7560
7561@noindent
7562stores the value 4 into that memory location.
7563
53a5351d 7564@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
7565@section Continuing at a different address
7566
7567Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
7568it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
7569an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
7570
7571@table @code
7572@kindex jump
7573@item jump @var{linespec}
7574Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
7575immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
7576source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
7577@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
7578in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
7579breakpoints}.
7580
7581The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
7582the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
7583register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
7584a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
7585be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
7586of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
7587confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
7588executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
7589well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
7590
7591@item jump *@var{address}
7592Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
7593@end table
7594
c906108c 7595@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
7596On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
7597command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
7598difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
7599changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
7600example,
c906108c
SS
7601
7602@example
7603set $pc = 0x485
7604@end example
7605
7606@noindent
7607makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
7608address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
7609@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
7610
7611The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
7612up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
7613that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
7614detail.
7615
c906108c 7616@c @group
53a5351d 7617@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
7618@section Giving your program a signal
7619
7620@table @code
7621@kindex signal
7622@item signal @var{signal}
7623Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
7624signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
7625signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
7626SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
7627
7628Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
7629giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
7630a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
7631@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
7632signal.
7633
7634@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
7635after executing the command.
7636@end table
7637@c @end group
7638
7639Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
7640@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
7641causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
7642the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
7643passes the signal directly to your program.
7644
c906108c 7645
53a5351d 7646@node Returning
c906108c
SS
7647@section Returning from a function
7648
7649@table @code
7650@cindex returning from a function
7651@kindex return
7652@item return
7653@itemx return @var{expression}
7654You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
7655command. If you give an
7656@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
7657value.
7658@end table
7659
7660When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
7661(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
7662discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
7663be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
7664
7665This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
7666frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
7667innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
7668specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
7669of functions.
7670
7671The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
7672program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
7673returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
7674and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
7675selected stack frame returns naturally.
7676
53a5351d 7677@node Calling
c906108c
SS
7678@section Calling program functions
7679
7680@cindex calling functions
7681@kindex call
7682@table @code
7683@item call @var{expr}
7684Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
7685returned values.
7686@end table
7687
7688You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
7689execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
7690with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
7691is printed and saved in the value history.
7692
c906108c
SS
7693For the A29K, a user-controlled variable @code{call_scratch_address},
7694specifies the location of a scratch area to be used when @value{GDBN}
7695calls a function in the target. This is necessary because the usual
7696method of putting the scratch area on the stack does not work in systems
7697that have separate instruction and data spaces.
c906108c 7698
53a5351d 7699@node Patching
c906108c 7700@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 7701
c906108c
SS
7702@cindex patching binaries
7703@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 7704@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 7705
7a292a7a
SS
7706By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
7707executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
7708alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
7709patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
7710
7711If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
7712explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
7713want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
7714repairs.
7715
7716@table @code
7717@kindex set write
7718@item set write on
7719@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
7720If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
7721core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
7722off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
7723
7724If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
7725@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
7726write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
7727
7728@item show write
7729@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
7730Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
7731as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
7732@end table
7733
53a5351d 7734@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
7735@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
7736
7a292a7a
SS
7737@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
7738both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
7739program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
7740@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
7741
7742@menu
7743* Files:: Commands to specify files
7744* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
7745@end menu
7746
53a5351d 7747@node Files
c906108c 7748@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 7749
7a292a7a 7750@cindex symbol table
c906108c 7751@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
7752
7753You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
7754way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
7755@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
7756Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
7757
7758Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
7759@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
7760a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
7761to specify new files are useful.
7762
7763@table @code
7764@cindex executable file
7765@kindex file
7766@item file @var{filename}
7767Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
7768symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
7769executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
7770directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
7771@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
7772directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
7773to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
7774and your program, using the @code{path} command.
7775
c906108c
SS
7776On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file
7777@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
7778@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
7779@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
7780descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
7781(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
7782@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
7783for more information.
c906108c
SS
7784
7785@item file
7786@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
7787has on both executable file and the symbol table.
7788
7789@kindex exec-file
7790@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7791Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
7792in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
7793if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
7794discard information on the executable file.
7795
7796@kindex symbol-file
7797@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7798Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
7799searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
7800table and program to run from the same file.
7801
7802@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
7803program's symbol table.
7804
7805The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
7806of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
7807auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
7808the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
7809the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
7810
7811@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
7812executing it once.
7813
7814When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
7815understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
7816generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
7817other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
7818Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
7819using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
7820optimized code.
c906108c
SS
7821
7822For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
7823using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
7824symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
7825quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
7826details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
7827
7828The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
7829start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
7830occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
7831file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
7832pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
7833warnings and messages}.)
7834
c906108c
SS
7835We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
7836symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
7837symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
7838still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
7839in stabs format.
7840
7841@kindex readnow
7842@cindex reading symbols immediately
7843@cindex symbols, reading immediately
7844@kindex mapped
7845@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
7846@cindex saving symbol table
7847@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
7848@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
7849You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
7850tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
7851load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
7852entire symbol table available.
c906108c 7853
c906108c
SS
7854If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
7855@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
7856cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
7857file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
7858from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
7859than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
7860program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
7861starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
7862
7863You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
7864file has all the symbol information for your program.
7865
7866The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
7867@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
7868than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
7869it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
7870needed.
7871
7872The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
7873@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
7874symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
7875
7876@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
7877@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
7878@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
7879@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
7880@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
7881@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
7882@c files.
7883
7884@kindex core
7885@kindex core-file
7886@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7887Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
7888of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
7889address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
7890executable file itself for other parts.
7891
7892@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
7893to be used.
7894
7895Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
7896under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
7897wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
7898the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 7899(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 7900
c906108c
SS
7901@kindex add-symbol-file
7902@cindex dynamic linking
7903@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
7904@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
2acceee2
JM
7905@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @var{data_address} @var{bss_address}
7906@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-T}@var{section} @var{address}
c906108c
SS
7907The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table information
7908from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command when @var{filename}
7909has been dynamically loaded (by some other means) into the program that
7910is running. @var{address} should be the memory address at which the
7911file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure this out for itself.
2acceee2
JM
7912You can specify up to three addresses, in which case they are taken to be
7913the addresses of the text, data, and bss segments respectively.
7914For complicated cases, you can specify an arbitrary number of @r{-T}@var{section} @var{address}
7915pairs, to give an explicit section name and base address for that section.
7916You can specify any @var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
7917
7918The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
7919originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
7920@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data thus
7921read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data instead,
7922use the @code{symbol-file} command.
7923
7924@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
7925
7926You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
7927the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
7928table information for @var{filename}.
7929
7930@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
7931@item add-shared-symbol-file
7932The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
7933operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
7934shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
7935@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 7936
c906108c
SS
7937@kindex section
7938@item section
7939The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
7940the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
7941section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
7942specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
7943separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
7944the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
7945
7946@kindex info files
7947@kindex info target
7948@item info files
7949@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
7950@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
7951current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
7952including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
7953use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
7954command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
7955current ones.
7956
c906108c
SS
7957@end table
7958
7959All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
7960as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
7961name and remembers it that way.
7962
c906108c 7963@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
7964@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
7965libraries.
53a5351d 7966
c906108c
SS
7967@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
7968when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
7969(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
7970references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
7971debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
7972
7973On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
7974automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
7975
c906108c
SS
7976@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
7977@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
7978@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
7979
7980@table @code
7981@kindex info sharedlibrary
7982@kindex info share
7983@item info share
7984@itemx info sharedlibrary
7985Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
7986
7987@kindex sharedlibrary
7988@kindex share
7989@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
7990@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
7991Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
7992Unix regular expression.
7993As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
7994required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
7995@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
7996loaded.
7997@end table
7998
53a5351d
JM
7999On HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} detects the loading of a shared library
8000and automatically reads in symbols from the newly loaded library, up to
8001a threshold that is initially set but that you can modify if you wish.
c906108c
SS
8002
8003Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
8004loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
8005@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
8006automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
8007
8008To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
8009
8010@table @code
8011@kindex set auto-solib-add
8012@item set auto-solib-add @var{threshold}
8013Set the autoloading size threshold, in megabytes. If @var{threshold} is
8014nonzero, symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded
8015automatically when the inferior begins execution or when the dynamic
8016linker informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded, until
8017the symbol table of the program and libraries exceeds this threshold.
8018Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
8019@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 megabytes.
8020
8021@kindex show auto-solib-add
8022@item show auto-solib-add
8023Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
8024@end table
c906108c 8025
53a5351d 8026@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
8027@section Errors reading symbol files
8028
8029While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
8030such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
8031output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
8032they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
8033debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
8034about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
8035only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
8036times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
8037to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
8038complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
8039messages}).
8040
8041The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
8042
8043@table @code
8044@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
8045
8046The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
8047(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
8048error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
8049in its outer scope blocks.
8050
8051@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
8052the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
8053may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
8054function.
8055
8056@item block at @var{address} out of order
8057
8058The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
8059order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
8060do so.
8061
8062@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
8063locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
8064can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
8065@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
8066messages}.)
8067
8068@item bad block start address patched
8069
8070The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
8071smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
8072to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
8073
8074@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
8075starting on the previous source line.
8076
8077@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
8078
8079@cindex foo
8080Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
8081larger than the size of the string table.
8082
8083@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
8084name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
8085with this name.
8086
8087@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
8088
7a292a7a
SS
8089The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
8090not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 8091uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 8092
7a292a7a
SS
8093@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
8094This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 8095are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
8096debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
8097on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
8098and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
8099
8100@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 8101
7a292a7a 8102@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 8103
7a292a7a 8104@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
c906108c 8105The symbol information for a C++ member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
8106information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
8107it.
c906108c
SS
8108
8109@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
8110
8111@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 8112
c906108c
SS
8113@end table
8114
53a5351d 8115@node Targets
c906108c 8116@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 8117
c906108c
SS
8118@cindex debugging target
8119@kindex target
8120
8121A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
8122
8123Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
8124in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
8125you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
8126flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
8127host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
8128realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
8129command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
8130(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
8131
8132@menu
8133* Active Targets:: Active targets
8134* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
8135* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
8136* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 8137* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
8138
8139@end menu
8140
53a5351d 8141@node Active Targets
c906108c 8142@section Active targets
7a292a7a 8143
c906108c
SS
8144@cindex stacking targets
8145@cindex active targets
8146@cindex multiple targets
8147
c906108c 8148There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
8149executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
8150active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
8151start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
8152a core file.
c906108c
SS
8153
8154For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
8155@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
8156well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
8157@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
8158first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
8159requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
8160are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
8161read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
8162executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
8163
8164When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
8165target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
8166commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
8167an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
8168process target is active.
c906108c 8169
7a292a7a
SS
8170Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
8171core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 8172files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
8173the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
8174process}).
c906108c 8175
53a5351d 8176@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
8177@section Commands for managing targets
8178
8179@table @code
8180@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
8181Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
8182process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
8183facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
8184protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
8185
8186Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
8187typically include things like device names or host names to connect
8188with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
8189
8190The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
8191after executing the command.
8192
8193@kindex help target
8194@item help target
8195Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
8196currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
8197(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8198
8199@item help target @var{name}
8200Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
8201select it.
8202
8203@kindex set gnutarget
8204@item set gnutarget @var{args}
8205@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
8206knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
8207a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
8208with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
8209with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
8210
d4f3574e 8211@quotation
c906108c
SS
8212@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
8213you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 8214@end quotation
c906108c 8215
d4f3574e
SS
8216@noindent
8217@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c
SS
8218
8219@kindex show gnutarget
8220@item show gnutarget
8221Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
8222@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
8223@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
8224and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
8225@end table
8226
c906108c
SS
8227Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
8228configuration):
c906108c
SS
8229
8230@table @code
8231@kindex target exec
8232@item target exec @var{program}
8233An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
8234@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
8235
c906108c
SS
8236@kindex target core
8237@item target core @var{filename}
8238A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
8239@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
8240
8241@kindex target remote
8242@item target remote @var{dev}
8243Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
8244specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
8245@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 8246supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
8247some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
8248it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
8249
c906108c
SS
8250@kindex target sim
8251@item target sim
2df3850c 8252Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213
JM
8253In general,
8254@example
8255 target sim
8256 load
8257 run
8258@end example
d4f3574e 8259@noindent
104c1213 8260works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 8261drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
8262provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
8263see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
8264Processors}.
8265
c906108c
SS
8266@end table
8267
104c1213 8268Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
8269
8270@table @code
8271
c906108c
SS
8272@kindex target nrom
8273@item target nrom @var{dev}
8274NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
8275
c906108c
SS
8276@end table
8277
c906108c
SS
8278Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
8279your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
8280
8281Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
8282once you've successfully established a connection.
8283
8284@table @code
8285
8286@kindex load @var{filename}
8287@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
8288Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
8289@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
8290is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
8291on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
8292@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
8293the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
8294
8295If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
8296execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
8297target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
8298
8299The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
8300For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
8301link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
8302specifies a fixed address.
8303@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
8304
c906108c
SS
8305@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
8306@end table
8307
53a5351d 8308@node Byte Order
c906108c 8309@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 8310
c906108c
SS
8311@cindex choosing target byte order
8312@cindex target byte order
8313@kindex set endian big
8314@kindex set endian little
8315@kindex set endian auto
8316@kindex show endian
8317
8318Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
8319offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
8320orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
8321designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
8322which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 8323@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
8324
8325@table @code
8326@kindex set endian big
8327@item set endian big
8328Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
8329
8330@kindex set endian little
8331@item set endian little
8332Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
8333
8334@kindex set endian auto
8335@item set endian auto
8336Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
8337executable.
8338
8339@item show endian
8340Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
8341
8342@end table
8343
8344Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
8345data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
8346target system.
8347
53a5351d 8348@node Remote
c906108c
SS
8349@section Remote debugging
8350@cindex remote debugging
8351
8352If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
8353@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
8354For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
8355or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
8356powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
8357
8358Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
8359to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
8360@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
8361but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
8362write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
8363communicate with @value{GDBN}.
8364
8365Other remote targets may be available in your
8366configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 8367
c906108c 8368@menu
c906108c 8369* Remote Serial:: @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
c906108c
SS
8370@end menu
8371
104c1213
JM
8372@node Remote Serial
8373@subsection The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
7a292a7a 8374
104c1213
JM
8375@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
8376To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
8377@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
8378prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
8379program, you need:
c906108c 8380
104c1213
JM
8381@enumerate
8382@item
8383A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
8384have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
8385your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 8386
104c1213 8387@item
d4f3574e 8388A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 8389subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 8390
104c1213
JM
8391@item
8392A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
8393download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
8394manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
8395documentation.
8396@end enumerate
96baa820 8397
104c1213
JM
8398The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
8399communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
8400machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 8401
104c1213
JM
8402@table @emph
8403@item On the host,
8404@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
8405else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
8406(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
8407
8408@item On the target,
8409you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
8410implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
8411subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
8412
8413On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
8414@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
8415@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
8416@end table
96baa820 8417
104c1213
JM
8418The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
8419machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
8420@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 8421
104c1213
JM
8422@cindex remote serial stub list
8423These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 8424
104c1213
JM
8425@table @code
8426
8427@item i386-stub.c
8428@kindex i386-stub.c
8429@cindex Intel
8430@cindex i386
8431For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
8432
8433@item m68k-stub.c
8434@kindex m68k-stub.c
8435@cindex Motorola 680x0
8436@cindex m680x0
8437For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
8438
8439@item sh-stub.c
8440@kindex sh-stub.c
8441@cindex Hitachi
8442@cindex SH
8443For Hitachi SH architectures.
8444
8445@item sparc-stub.c
8446@kindex sparc-stub.c
8447@cindex Sparc
8448For @sc{sparc} architectures.
8449
8450@item sparcl-stub.c
8451@kindex sparcl-stub.c
8452@cindex Fujitsu
8453@cindex SparcLite
8454For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
8455
8456@end table
8457
8458The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
8459recently added stubs.
8460
8461@menu
8462* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
8463* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
8464* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
8465* Protocol:: Definition of the communication protocol
8466* Server:: Using the `gdbserver' program
8467* NetWare:: Using the `gdbserve.nlm' program
8468@end menu
8469
8470@node Stub Contents
8471@subsubsection What the stub can do for you
8472
8473@cindex remote serial stub
8474The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
8475subroutines:
8476
8477@table @code
8478@item set_debug_traps
8479@kindex set_debug_traps
8480@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
8481This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
8482program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
8483beginning of your program.
8484
8485@item handle_exception
8486@kindex handle_exception
8487@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
8488This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
8489explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
8490run when a trap is triggered.
8491
8492@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
8493execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
8494with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
8495protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 8496representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
8497information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
8498retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
8499execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
8500@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
8501machine.
8502
8503@item breakpoint
8504@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
8505Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
8506breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
8507way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
8508machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
8509pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
8510@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
8511simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
8512again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
8513your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
8514@value{GDBN} session gets control.
8515
8516Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
8517to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
8518start of your debugging session.
8519@end table
8520
8521@node Bootstrapping
8522@subsubsection What you must do for the stub
8523
8524@cindex remote stub, support routines
8525The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
8526chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
8527debugging target machine.
8528
8529First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
8530serial port.
8531
8532@table @code
8533@item int getDebugChar()
8534@kindex getDebugChar
8535Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
8536It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
8537different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
8538
8539@item void putDebugChar(int)
8540@kindex putDebugChar
8541Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
8542It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
8543different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
8544@end table
8545
8546@cindex control C, and remote debugging
8547@cindex interrupting remote targets
8548If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
8549running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
8550for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
8551character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
8552remote system to stop.
8553
8554Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
8555probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
8556is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
8557@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
8558
8559Other routines you need to supply are:
8560
8561@table @code
8562@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
8563@kindex exceptionHandler
8564Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
8565handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
8566way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
8567are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
8568containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
8569@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
8570its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
8571might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
8572exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
8573@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
8574and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
8575you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
8576should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
8577
8578For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
8579gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
8580should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
8581@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
8582help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
8583
8584@item void flush_i_cache()
8585@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 8586On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
8587instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
8588instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
8589
8590On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
8591function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
8592@end table
8593
8594@noindent
8595You must also make sure this library routine is available:
8596
8597@table @code
8598@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
8599@kindex memset
8600This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
8601memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
8602@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
8603either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
8604@end table
8605
8606If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
8607library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
8608but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 8609subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
8610
8611
8612@node Debug Session
8613@subsubsection Putting it all together
8614
8615@cindex remote serial debugging summary
8616In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
8617steps.
8618
8619@enumerate
8620@item
8621Make sure you have the supporting low-level routines
8622(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
8623@display
8624@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
8625@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
8626@end display
8627
8628@item
8629Insert these lines near the top of your program:
8630
8631@example
8632set_debug_traps();
8633breakpoint();
8634@end example
8635
8636@item
8637For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
8638@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
8639
8640@example
8641void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
8642@end example
8643
d4f3574e 8644@noindent
104c1213 8645but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
d4f3574e 8646function in your program; that function is called when
104c1213
JM
8647@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
8648error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
8649one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
8650
8651@item
8652Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
8653your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
8654
8655@item
8656Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
8657the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
8658
8659@item
8660@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
8661@c document that. FIXME.
8662Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
8663whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
8664
8665@item
8666To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
8667as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
8668This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
8669of its pure text.
8670
d4f3574e 8671@item
104c1213 8672@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 8673Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
8674Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
8675machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
8676TCP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
8677to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
8678device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
8679
8680@example
8681target remote /dev/ttyb
8682@end example
8683
8684@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
8685To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
8686@code{@var{host}:port}. For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
8687terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
8688
8689@example
8690target remote manyfarms:2828
8691@end example
8692@end enumerate
8693
8694Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
8695step and continue the remote program.
8696
8697To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
8698command.
8699
8700@cindex interrupting remote programs
8701@cindex remote programs, interrupting
8702Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
8703interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
8704program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
8705and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
8706interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
8707
8708@example
8709Interrupted while waiting for the program.
8710Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
8711@end example
8712
8713If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
8714(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
8715remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
8716goes back to waiting.
8717
8718@node Protocol
8719@subsubsection Communication protocol
8720
8721@cindex debugging stub, example
8722@cindex remote stub, example
8723@cindex stub example, remote debugging
8724The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
8725communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
8726@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
8727these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
8728implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
8729with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
8730organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
8731
8732However, there may be occasions when you need to know something about
8733the protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your
8734target machine, you might want your program to do something special if
8735it recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
8736
8737In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
8738transmitted and received data respectfully.
8739
8740@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
8741@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
8742@cindex remote serial protocol
8743All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments)
8744are sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the
8745character @samp{$}, this is followed by an optional two-digit
8746@var{sequence-id} and the character @samp{:}, the actual
8747@var{packet-data}, and the terminating character @samp{#} followed by a
8748two-digit @var{checksum}:
8749
8750@example
8751@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8752@end example
8753@noindent
8754or, with the optional @var{sequence-id}:
8755@example
8756@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8757@end example
8758
8759@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
8760@noindent
8761The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
8762characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (that
8763consisting of both the optional @var{sequence-id}@code{:} and the actual
d4f3574e 8764@var{packet-data}) (an eight bit unsigned checksum).
104c1213
JM
8765
8766@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
8767@noindent
8768The two-digit @var{sequence-id}, when present, is returned with the
8769acknowledgment. Beyond that its meaning is poorly defined.
8770@value{GDBN} is not known to output @var{sequence-id}s.
8771
8772When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
8773response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
8774the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
8775retransmission):
8776
8777@example
8778<- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8779-> @code{+}
8780@end example
8781@noindent
8782If the received packet included a @var{sequence-id} than that is
8783appended to a positive acknowledgment:
8784
8785@example
8786<- @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8787-> @code{+}@var{sequence-id}
8788@end example
8789
8790The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
8791debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
8792the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
8793when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
8794
8795@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
8796exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for an
8797exception). @samp{:} can not appear as the third character in a packet.
8798Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} and @samp{;}
8799(unfortunately some packets chose to use @samp{:}). Except where
8800otherwise noted all numbers are represented in HEX with leading zeros
8801suppressed.
8802
8803Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
c3f6f71d 8804means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
104c1213
JM
8805which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
8806@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
d4f3574e
SS
8807where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
8808characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
8809value greater than 126 should not be used.
8810
8811Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
8812loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
8813character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
104c1213
JM
8814
8815So:
8816@example
8817"@code{0* }"
8818@end example
8819@noindent
8820means the same as "0000".
8821
8822The error response, returned for some packets includes a two character
8823error number. That number is not well defined.
8824
8825For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
8826(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
8827protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
d4f3574e 8828on that response.
104c1213
JM
8829
8830Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
8831their corresponding response @var{data}:
8832
8833@multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
8834@item Packet
8835@tab Request
8836@tab Description
8837
8838@item extended ops @emph{(optional)}
8839@tab @code{!}
8840@tab
d4f3574e 8841Use the extended remote protocol. Sticky---only needs to be set once.
104c1213
JM
8842The extended remote protocol support the @samp{R} packet.
8843@item
8844@tab reply @samp{}
8845@tab
8846Stubs that support the extended remote protocol return @samp{} which,
8847unfortunately, is identical to the response returned by stubs that do not
8848support protocol extensions.
8849
8850@item last signal
8851@tab @code{?}
8852@tab
d4f3574e
SS
8853Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for step
8854and continue.
8855@item
8856@tab reply
8857@tab see below
8858
104c1213
JM
8859
8860@item reserved
8861@tab @code{a}
8862@tab Reserved for future use
8863
8864@item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)} @emph{(optional)}
8865@tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
8866@tab
8867Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
8868specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
d4f3574e 8869See @file{gdbserver} for more details.
104c1213
JM
8870@item
8871@tab reply @code{OK}
8872@item
8873@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8874
8875@item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
8876@tab @code{b}@var{baud}
8877@tab
8878Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. JTC: @emph{When does the
8879transport layer state change? When it's received, or after the ACK is
8880transmitted. In either case, there are problems if the command or the
8881acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
8882to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
8883ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
8884specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
8885that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
8886happened.}
8887
8888@item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
8889@tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
8890@tab
8891Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
8892breakpoint at @var{addr}. @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
8893@samp{z} packets.}
8894
8895@item continue
8896@tab @code{c}@var{addr}
8897@tab
8898@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
8899current address.
8900@item
8901@tab reply
8902@tab see below
8903
8904@item continue with signal @emph{(optional)}
8905@tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
8906@tab
8907Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
8908@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
8909@item
8910@tab reply
8911@tab see below
8912
d4f3574e 8913@item toggle debug @emph{(deprecated)}
104c1213
JM
8914@tab @code{d}
8915@tab
d4f3574e 8916toggle debug flag.
104c1213
JM
8917
8918@item detach @emph{(optional)}
8919@tab @code{D}
d4f3574e 8920@tab
2df3850c
JM
8921Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target before
8922@value{GDBN} disconnects.
d4f3574e
SS
8923@item
8924@tab reply @emph{no response}
8925@tab
2df3850c 8926@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet
104c1213
JM
8927
8928@item reserved
8929@tab @code{e}
8930@tab Reserved for future use
8931
8932@item reserved
8933@tab @code{E}
8934@tab Reserved for future use
8935
8936@item reserved
8937@tab @code{f}
8938@tab Reserved for future use
8939
8940@item reserved
8941@tab @code{F}
8942@tab Reserved for future use
8943
8944@item read registers
8945@tab @code{g}
8946@tab Read general registers.
8947@item
8948@tab reply @var{XX...}
8949@tab
8950Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
8951with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
d4f3574e 8952each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
2df3850c 8953determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and
d4f3574e
SS
8954@var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
8955@code{g} packets is specified below.
104c1213
JM
8956@item
8957@tab @code{E}@var{NN}
8958@tab for an error.
8959
8960@item write regs
8961@tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
8962@tab
8963See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
8964@item
8965@tab reply @code{OK}
8966@tab for success
8967@item
8968@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8969@tab for an error
8970
8971@item reserved
8972@tab @code{h}
8973@tab Reserved for future use
8974
8975@item set thread @emph{(optional)}
8976@tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
8977@tab
d4f3574e
SS
8978Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
8979@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread used in step and
8980continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads. @var{c} = @samp{g} for
8981thread used in other operations. If zero, pick a thread, any thread.
104c1213
JM
8982@item
8983@tab reply @code{OK}
8984@tab for success
8985@item
8986@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8987@tab for an error
8988
d4f3574e
SS
8989@c FIXME: JTC:
8990@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
8991@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
8992@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
8993@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
8994@c described. For example:
8995@c
8996@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
8997@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
8998@c otherwise returns current registers.
8999@c
9000@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9001@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
9002@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
9003
104c1213
JM
9004@item cycle step @strong{(draft)} @emph{(optional)}
9005@tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
9006@tab
9007Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
9008present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
9009step starting at that address.
9010
9011@item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)} @emph{(optional)}
9012@tab @code{I}
9013@tab
9014See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
9015
9016@item reserved
9017@tab @code{j}
9018@tab Reserved for future use
9019
9020@item reserved
9021@tab @code{J}
9022@tab Reserved for future use
9023
9024@item kill request @emph{(optional)}
9025@tab @code{k}
9026@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9027FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how operate when a specific
9028thread context has been selected (ie. does 'k' kill only that thread?)}.
104c1213
JM
9029
9030@item reserved
9031@tab @code{l}
9032@tab Reserved for future use
9033
9034@item reserved
9035@tab @code{L}
9036@tab Reserved for future use
9037
9038@item read memory
9039@tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9040@tab
9041Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
2df3850c 9042Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are assumed
d4f3574e
SS
9043using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
9044transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
9045@item
9046@tab reply @var{XX...}
9047@tab
d4f3574e 9048@var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
2df3850c 9049to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that
d4f3574e
SS
9050sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME:
9051@emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
9052@item
9053@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9054@tab @var{NN} is errno
9055
9056@item write mem
9057@tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
9058@tab
9059Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
9060@var{XX...} is the data.
9061@item
9062@tab reply @code{OK}
9063@tab for success
9064@item
9065@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9066@tab
9067for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
9068written).
9069
9070@item reserved
9071@tab @code{n}
9072@tab Reserved for future use
9073
9074@item reserved
9075@tab @code{N}
9076@tab Reserved for future use
9077
9078@item reserved
9079@tab @code{o}
9080@tab Reserved for future use
9081
9082@item reserved
9083@tab @code{O}
9084@tab Reserved for future use
9085
9086@item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
9087@tab @code{p}@var{n...}
9088@tab
9089See write register.
9090@item
9091@tab return @var{r....}
9092@tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
9093
9094@item write reg @emph{(optional)}
9095@tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
9096@tab
9097Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
9098digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
9099@item
9100@tab reply @code{OK}
9101@tab for success
9102@item
9103@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9104@tab for an error
9105
9106@item general query @emph{(optional)}
9107@tab @code{q}@var{query}
9108@tab
d4f3574e 9109Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} @var{query}'s
104c1213 9110have a leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a
d4f3574e
SS
9111company prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may
9112optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs
9113must ensure that they match the full @var{query} name.
104c1213
JM
9114@item
9115@tab reply @code{XX...}
d4f3574e 9116@tab Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
104c1213
JM
9117@item
9118@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9119@tab error reply
9120@item
9121@tab reply @samp{}
9122@tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
9123
104c1213
JM
9124@item general set @emph{(optional)}
9125@tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
9126@tab
9127Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}. See @samp{q} for a discussing of
9128naming conventions.
9129
d4f3574e
SS
9130@item reset @emph{(deprecated)}
9131@tab @code{r}
9132@tab
9133Reset the entire system.
104c1213
JM
9134
9135@item remote restart @emph{(optional)}
9136@tab @code{R}@var{XX}
9137@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9138Restart the remote server. @var{XX} while needed has no clear
9139definition. FIXME: @emph{An example interaction explaining how this
9140packet is used in extended-remote mode is needed}.
104c1213
JM
9141
9142@item step @emph{(optional)}
9143@tab @code{s}@var{addr}
9144@tab
9145@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
9146same address.
9147@item
9148@tab reply
9149@tab see below
9150
9151@item step with signal @emph{(optional)}
9152@tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9153@tab
9154Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
9155@item
9156@tab reply
9157@tab see below
9158
9159@item search @emph{(optional)}
9160@tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
9161@tab
9162Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
9163@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
d4f3574e 9164bytes. @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
104c1213
JM
9165
9166@item thread alive @emph{(optional)}
9167@tab @code{T}@var{XX}
9168@tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
9169@item
9170@tab reply @code{OK}
9171@tab thread is still alive
9172@item
9173@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9174@tab thread is dead
9175
9176@item reserved
9177@tab @code{u}
9178@tab Reserved for future use
9179
9180@item reserved
9181@tab @code{U}
9182@tab Reserved for future use
9183
9184@item reserved
9185@tab @code{v}
9186@tab Reserved for future use
9187
9188@item reserved
9189@tab @code{V}
9190@tab Reserved for future use
9191
9192@item reserved
9193@tab @code{w}
9194@tab Reserved for future use
9195
9196@item reserved
9197@tab @code{W}
9198@tab Reserved for future use
9199
9200@item reserved
9201@tab @code{x}
9202@tab Reserved for future use
9203
9204@item write mem (binary) @emph{(optional)}
9205@tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
9206@tab
9207@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
d4f3574e
SS
9208binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
9209escaped using @code{0x7d}.
104c1213
JM
9210@item
9211@tab reply @code{OK}
9212@tab for success
9213@item
9214@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9215@tab for an error
9216
9217@item reserved
9218@tab @code{y}
9219@tab Reserved for future use
9220
9221@item reserved
9222@tab @code{Y}
9223@tab Reserved for future use
9224
9225@item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)} @emph{(optional)}
9226@tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9227@tab
9228See @samp{Z}.
9229
9230@item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)} @emph{(optional)}
9231@tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9232@tab
9233@var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
9234breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
9235@samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
9236bytes. For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
9237the instruction to be patched. For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
d4f3574e
SS
9238@var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored. To avoid
9239potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be
9240implemented in an ident-potentent way.
104c1213
JM
9241@item
9242@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9243@tab for an error
9244@item
9245@tab reply @code{OK}
9246@tab for success
9247@item
9248@tab @samp{}
9249@tab If not supported.
9250
9251@item reserved
9252@tab <other>
9253@tab Reserved for future use
9254
9255@end multitable
9256
d4f3574e
SS
9257The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
9258receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
9259@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
9260when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
9261number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
9262conventions is used.
104c1213
JM
9263
9264@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
9265
9266@item @code{S}@var{AA}
9267@tab @var{AA} is the signal number
9268
9269@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
9270@tab
9271@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
9272(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
9273by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
9274thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not
d4f3574e 9275starting with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this
104c1213
JM
9276@var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can
9277extend the protocol.
9278
9279@item @code{W}@var{AA}
9280@tab
9281The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
9282applicable for certains sorts of targets.
9283
9284@item @code{X}@var{AA}
9285@tab
9286The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
9287
9288@item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{tttttttt}@code{;}@var{dddddddd}@code{;}@var{bbbbbbbb} @strong{(obsolete)}
9289@tab
9290@var{AA} = signal number; @var{tttttttt} = address of symbol "_start";
9291@var{dddddddd} = base of data section; @var{bbbbbbbb} = base of bss
d4f3574e 9292section. @emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets. The difference
104c1213
JM
9293between this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may
9294arrive spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the
9295host debugger.}
9296
9297@item @code{O}@var{XX...}
9298@tab
c3f6f71d 9299@var{XX...} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at any time
104c1213
JM
9300while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
9301for 'W', 'T', etc.
9302
9303@end multitable
9304
d4f3574e
SS
9305The following set and query packets have already been defined.
9306
9307@multitable @columnfractions .2 .2 .6
9308
9309@item current thread
9310@tab @code{q}@code{C}
9311@tab Return the current thread id.
9312@item
9313@tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
9314@tab
9315Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
9316@item
9317@tab reply *
9318@tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
9319
9320@item compute CRC of memory block
9321@tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9322@tab
9323@item
9324@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9325@tab An error (such as memory fault)
9326@item
9327@tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
9328@tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
9329
9330@item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
9331@tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
9332@tab
9333Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
9334digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
9335subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
9336number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
9337(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
9338returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
9339@item
9340@tab reply @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread...}
9341@tab
9342Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
9343returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
9344and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
9345digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread...} is
9346a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
9347digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
9348
9349@item query sect offs
9350@tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
917317f4
JM
9351@tab
9352Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
9353image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
9354response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
9355offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
d4f3574e
SS
9356@item
9357@tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
9358
9359@item thread info request
9360@tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
9361@tab
9362Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
9363encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
9364@item
9365@tab reply *
9366@tab
9367See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
9368
9369@item remote command
9370@tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
9371@tab
9372@var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
9373execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
9374Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
9375number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
9376packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
9377stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
9378@item
9379@tab reply @code{OK}
9380@tab
9381A command response with no output.
9382@item
9383@tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
9384@tab
9385A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
9386@item
9387@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9388@tab
9389Indicate a badly formed request.
9390
9391@item
9392@tab reply @samp{}
9393@tab
9394When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
9395
9396@end multitable
9397
9398The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
9399In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as sixty-four
9400bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) to fill the
9401space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target byte order.
9402The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered most-significant -
9403least-significant.
9404
9405@multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
9406
9407@item MIPS32
9408@tab
9409All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
941032 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
9411registers; fsr; fir; fp.
9412
9413@item MIPS64
9414@tab
9415All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
9416thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
9417as @code{MIPS32}.
9418
9419@end multitable
9420
104c1213
JM
9421Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
9422does not get any direct output:
9423
9424@example
9425<- @code{R00}
9426-> @code{+}
9427@emph{target restarts}
9428<- @code{?}
9429-> @code{+}
9430-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
9431<- @code{+}
9432@end example
9433
9434Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
9435
9436@example
9437<- @code{G1445...}
9438-> @code{+}
9439<- @code{s}
9440-> @code{+}
9441@emph{time passes}
9442-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
9443<- @code{+}
9444<- @code{g}
9445-> @code{+}
9446-> @code{1455...}
9447<- @code{+}
9448@end example
9449
d4f3574e
SS
9450@kindex set remotedebug@r{, serial protocol}
9451@kindex show remotedebug@r{, serial protocol}
104c1213
JM
9452@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
9453@cindex serial connections, debugging
9454If you have trouble with the serial connection, you can use the command
9455@code{set remotedebug}. This makes @value{GDBN} report on all packets sent
9456back and forth across the serial line to the remote machine. The
9457packet-debugging information is printed on the @value{GDBN} standard output
9458stream. @code{set remotedebug off} turns it off, and @code{show
9459remotedebug} shows you its current state.
9460
9461@node Server
9462@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserver} program
9463
9464@kindex gdbserver
9465@cindex remote connection without stubs
9466@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
9467allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9468@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
9469
9470@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
9471because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
9472that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
9473@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
9474@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
9475because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
9476also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
9477started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
9478Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
9479the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
9480do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
9481by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
9482choice for debugging.
9483
9484@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
9485or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
9486protocol.
9487
9488@table @emph
9489@item On the target machine,
9490you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9491@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
9492strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
9493system does all the symbol handling.
9494
9495To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
9496the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The
9497syntax is:
9498
9499@smallexample
9500target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9501@end smallexample
9502
9503@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
9504hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
9505@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
9506@file{/dev/com1}:
9507
9508@smallexample
9509target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
9510@end smallexample
9511
9512@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
9513with it.
9514
9515To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
9516
9517@smallexample
9518target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
9519@end smallexample
9520
9521The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
9522specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
9523TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
9524expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
9525(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
9526you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
9527TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
9528reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
9529conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
d4f3574e 9530and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
9531@code{target remote} command.
9532
9533@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9534you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9535symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9536using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9537(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 9538running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
9539remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
9540is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
9541@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
9542@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
9543
9544@smallexample
9545(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9546@end smallexample
9547
9548@noindent
9549communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
9550
9551@smallexample
9552(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
9553@end smallexample
9554
9555@noindent
9556communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
9557For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
9558the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
9559text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
9560@samp{Connection refused}.
9561@end table
9562
9563@node NetWare
9564@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
9565
9566@kindex gdbserve.nlm
9567@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
9568allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9569@code{target remote}.
9570
9571@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
9572using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
9573
9574@table @emph
9575@item On the target machine,
9576you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9577@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
9578can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
9579host system does all the symbol handling.
9580
9581To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
9582@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
9583program. The syntax is:
9584
9585@smallexample
9586load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
9587 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9588@end smallexample
9589
9590@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
9591the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
d4f3574e 9592to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
104c1213
JM
9593
9594For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
9595communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
d4f3574e 9596using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
104c1213
JM
9597
9598@smallexample
9599load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
9600@end smallexample
9601
9602@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9603you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9604symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9605using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9606(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 9607running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
9608remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
9609argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
9610@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
9611
9612@smallexample
9613(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9614@end smallexample
9615
9616@noindent
9617communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
9618@end table
9619
9620@node KOD
9621@section Kernel Object Display
9622
9623@cindex kernel object display
9624@cindex kernel object
9625@cindex KOD
9626
9627Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
9628@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
9629and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
9630mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
9631displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
9632
9633Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
9634@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
9635
9636@example
2df3850c 9637(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
104c1213
JM
9638@end example
9639
9640If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
9641about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
9642which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
9643after the operating system:
9644
9645@example
2df3850c 9646(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
104c1213
JM
9647List of Cisco Kernel Objects
9648Object Description
9649any Any and all objects
9650@end example
9651
9652Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
9653by the kernel.
9654
9655There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
96baa820
JM
9656is supported other than to try it.
9657
9658
104c1213
JM
9659@node Configurations
9660@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
9661
9662While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
9663cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
9664describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
9665
9666There are three major categories of configurations: native
9667configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
9668operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
9669different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
9670are quite different from each other.
9671
9672@menu
9673* Native::
9674* Embedded OS::
9675* Embedded Processors::
9676* Architectures::
9677@end menu
9678
9679@node Native
9680@section Native
9681
9682This section describes details specific to particular native
9683configurations.
9684
9685@menu
9686* HP-UX:: HP-UX
9687* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
9688@end menu
9689
9690@node HP-UX
9691@subsection HP-UX
9692
9693On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
9694begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
9695name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
9696
9697@node SVR4 Process Information
9698@subsection SVR4 process information
9699
9700@kindex /proc
9701@cindex process image
9702
9703Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
9704used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
9705subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
9706this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
9707several kinds of information about the process running your program.
9708@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
9709@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
9710and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
9711
9712@table @code
9713@kindex info proc
9714@item info proc
9715Summarize available information about the process.
9716
9717@kindex info proc mappings
9718@item info proc mappings
9719Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
9720on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
9721
9722@kindex info proc times
9723@item info proc times
9724Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
9725its children.
9726
9727@kindex info proc id
9728@item info proc id
9729Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
9730the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
9731
9732@kindex info proc status
9733@item info proc status
9734General information on the state of the process. If the process is
9735stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
9736received.
9737
9738@item info proc all
9739Show all the above information about the process.
9740@end table
9741
9742@node Embedded OS
9743@section Embedded Operating Systems
9744
9745This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
9746embedded operating systems that are available for several different
9747architectures.
9748
9749@menu
9750* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
9751@end menu
9752
9753@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
9754various real-time operating systems.
9755
9756@node VxWorks
9757@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
9758
9759@cindex VxWorks
9760
9761@table @code
9762
9763@kindex target vxworks
9764@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
9765A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
9766is the target system's machine name or IP address.
9767
9768@end table
9769
9770On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
9771current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
9772
9773@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
9774VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
9775the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
9776both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
d4f3574e 9777@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
104c1213 9778installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
d4f3574e 9779@value{GDB} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213
JM
9780
9781@table @code
9782@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
9783@kindex vxworks-timeout
9784All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
9785This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
9786seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
9787your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
9788of a thin network line.
9789@end table
9790
9791The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
9792this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
9793procedures.
9794
9795@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
9796To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
9797to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
9798library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
9799VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
9800kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
9801source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
9802information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
9803manual.
9804@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
9805
9806Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
9807your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
d4f3574e 9808run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or @code{vxgdb},
104c1213
JM
9809depending on your installation).
9810
9811@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
9812
9813@example
9814(vxgdb)
9815@end example
9816
9817@menu
9818* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
9819* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
9820* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
9821@end menu
9822
9823@node VxWorks Connection
9824@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
9825
9826The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
9827network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
9828
9829@example
9830(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
9831@end example
9832
9833@need 750
9834@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
9835
9836@smallexample
9837Attaching remote machine across net...
9838Connected to tt.
9839@end smallexample
9840
9841@need 1000
9842@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
9843loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
9844these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
9845path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
9846to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
9847
9848@example
9849prog.o: No such file or directory.
9850@end example
9851
9852When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
9853the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
9854command again.
9855
9856@node VxWorks Download
9857@subsubsection VxWorks download
9858
9859@cindex download to VxWorks
9860If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
9861object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
9862@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
9863incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
9864command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
9865to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
9866table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
9867the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
9868filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
9869Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
9870to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
9871the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
9872@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
9873and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
9874program, type this on VxWorks:
9875
9876@example
9877-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
9878@end example
d4f3574e
SS
9879
9880@noindent
104c1213
JM
9881Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
9882
9883@example
9884(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
9885(vxgdb) load prog.o
9886@end example
9887
9888@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
9889
9890@smallexample
9891Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
9892@end smallexample
9893
9894You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
9895after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
9896this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
9897auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
9898history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
d4f3574e 9899debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
104c1213
JM
9900table.)
9901
9902@node VxWorks Attach
9903@subsubsection Running tasks
9904
9905@cindex running VxWorks tasks
9906You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
9907follows:
9908
9909@example
9910(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
9911@end example
9912
9913@noindent
9914where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
9915or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
9916the time of attachment.
9917
9918@node Embedded Processors
9919@section Embedded Processors
9920
9921This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
9922configurations.
9923
9924@menu
9925* A29K Embedded:: AMD A29K Embedded
9926* ARM:: ARM
9927* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
9928* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
9929* i960:: Intel i960
9930* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
9931* M68K:: Motorola M68K
9932* M88K:: Motorola M88K
9933* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
9934* PA:: HP PA Embedded
9935* PowerPC: PowerPC
9936* SH:: Hitachi SH
9937* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
9938* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
9939* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
9940* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
9941@end menu
9942
9943@node A29K Embedded
9944@subsection AMD A29K Embedded
9945
9946@menu
9947* A29K UDI::
9948* A29K EB29K::
9949* Comms (EB29K):: Communications setup
9950* gdb-EB29K:: EB29K cross-debugging
9951* Remote Log:: Remote log
9952@end menu
9953
9954@table @code
9955
9956@kindex target adapt
9957@item target adapt @var{dev}
9958Adapt monitor for A29K.
9959
9960@kindex target amd-eb
9961@item target amd-eb @var{dev} @var{speed} @var{PROG}
9962@cindex AMD EB29K
9963Remote PC-resident AMD EB29K board, attached over serial lines.
9964@var{dev} is the serial device, as for @code{target remote};
9965@var{speed} allows you to specify the linespeed; and @var{PROG} is the
9966name of the program to be debugged, as it appears to DOS on the PC.
9967@xref{A29K EB29K, ,EBMON protocol for AMD29K}.
9968
9969@end table
9970
9971@node A29K UDI
9972@subsubsection A29K UDI
9973
9974@cindex UDI
9975@cindex AMD29K via UDI
9976
9977@value{GDBN} supports AMD's UDI (``Universal Debugger Interface'')
9978protocol for debugging the a29k processor family. To use this
9979configuration with AMD targets running the MiniMON monitor, you need the
9980program @code{MONTIP}, available from AMD at no charge. You can also
9981use @value{GDBN} with the UDI-conformant a29k simulator program
9982@code{ISSTIP}, also available from AMD.
9983
9984@table @code
9985@item target udi @var{keyword}
9986@kindex udi
9987Select the UDI interface to a remote a29k board or simulator, where
9988@var{keyword} is an entry in the AMD configuration file @file{udi_soc}.
9989This file contains keyword entries which specify parameters used to
9990connect to a29k targets. If the @file{udi_soc} file is not in your
9991working directory, you must set the environment variable @samp{UDICONF}
9992to its pathname.
9993@end table
9994
9995@node A29K EB29K
9996@subsubsection EBMON protocol for AMD29K
9997
9998@cindex EB29K board
9999@cindex running 29K programs
10000
10001AMD distributes a 29K development board meant to fit in a PC, together
10002with a DOS-hosted monitor program called @code{EBMON}. As a shorthand
10003term, this development system is called the ``EB29K''. To use
10004@value{GDBN} from a Unix system to run programs on the EB29K board, you
10005must first connect a serial cable between the PC (which hosts the EB29K
10006board) and a serial port on the Unix system. In the following, we
10007assume you've hooked the cable between the PC's @file{COM1} port and
10008@file{/dev/ttya} on the Unix system.
10009
10010@node Comms (EB29K)
10011@subsubsection Communications setup
10012
10013The next step is to set up the PC's port, by doing something like this
10014in DOS on the PC:
10015
10016@example
10017C:\> MODE com1:9600,n,8,1,none
10018@end example
10019
10020@noindent
10021This example---run on an MS DOS 4.0 system---sets the PC port to 9600
10022bps, no parity, eight data bits, one stop bit, and no ``retry'' action;
10023you must match the communications parameters when establishing the Unix
10024end of the connection as well.
10025@c FIXME: Who knows what this "no retry action" crud from the DOS manual may
10026@c mean? It's optional; leave it out? ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
10027@c
10028@c It's optional, but it's unwise to omit it: who knows what is the
10029@c default value set when the DOS machines boots? "No retry" means that
10030@c the DOS serial device driver won't retry the operation if it fails;
10031@c I understand that this is needed because the GDB serial protocol
10032@c handles any errors and retransmissions itself. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3sep99
104c1213
JM
10033
10034To give control of the PC to the Unix side of the serial line, type
10035the following at the DOS console:
10036
10037@example
10038C:\> CTTY com1
10039@end example
10040
10041@noindent
10042(Later, if you wish to return control to the DOS console, you can use
10043the command @code{CTTY con}---but you must send it over the device that
10044had control, in our example over the @file{COM1} serial line).
10045
10046From the Unix host, use a communications program such as @code{tip} or
10047@code{cu} to communicate with the PC; for example,
10048
10049@example
10050cu -s 9600 -l /dev/ttya
10051@end example
10052
10053@noindent
10054The @code{cu} options shown specify, respectively, the linespeed and the
10055serial port to use. If you use @code{tip} instead, your command line
10056may look something like the following:
10057
10058@example
10059tip -9600 /dev/ttya
10060@end example
10061
10062@noindent
10063Your system may require a different name where we show
10064@file{/dev/ttya} as the argument to @code{tip}. The communications
10065parameters, including which port to use, are associated with the
10066@code{tip} argument in the ``remote'' descriptions file---normally the
10067system table @file{/etc/remote}.
10068@c FIXME: What if anything needs doing to match the "n,8,1,none" part of
10069@c the DOS side's comms setup? cu can support -o (odd
10070@c parity), -e (even parity)---apparently no settings for no parity or
10071@c for character size. Taken from stty maybe...? John points out tip
10072@c can set these as internal variables, eg ~s parity=none; man stty
10073@c suggests that it *might* work to stty these options with stdin or
10074@c stdout redirected... ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
10075@c
10076@c There's nothing to be done for the "none" part of the DOS MODE
10077@c command. The rest of the parameters should be matched by the
10078@c baudrate, bits, and parity used by the Unix side. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3Sep99
104c1213
JM
10079
10080@kindex EBMON
10081Using the @code{tip} or @code{cu} connection, change the DOS working
10082directory to the directory containing a copy of your 29K program, then
10083start the PC program @code{EBMON} (an EB29K control program supplied
10084with your board by AMD). You should see an initial display from
10085@code{EBMON} similar to the one that follows, ending with the
10086@code{EBMON} prompt @samp{#}---
10087
10088@example
10089C:\> G:
10090
10091G:\> CD \usr\joe\work29k
10092
10093G:\USR\JOE\WORK29K> EBMON
10094Am29000 PC Coprocessor Board Monitor, version 3.0-18
10095Copyright 1990 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.
10096Written by Gibbons and Associates, Inc.
10097
10098Enter '?' or 'H' for help
10099
10100PC Coprocessor Type = EB29K
10101I/O Base = 0x208
10102Memory Base = 0xd0000
10103
10104Data Memory Size = 2048KB
10105Available I-RAM Range = 0x8000 to 0x1fffff
10106Available D-RAM Range = 0x80002000 to 0x801fffff
10107
10108PageSize = 0x400
10109Register Stack Size = 0x800
10110Memory Stack Size = 0x1800
10111
10112CPU PRL = 0x3
10113Am29027 Available = No
10114Byte Write Available = Yes
10115
10116# ~.
10117@end example
10118
10119Then exit the @code{cu} or @code{tip} program (done in the example by
10120typing @code{~.} at the @code{EBMON} prompt). @code{EBMON} keeps
10121running, ready for @value{GDBN} to take over.
10122
10123For this example, we've assumed what is probably the most convenient
10124way to make sure the same 29K program is on both the PC and the Unix
d4f3574e 10125system: a PC/NFS connection that establishes ``drive @file{G:}'' on the
104c1213
JM
10126PC as a file system on the Unix host. If you do not have PC/NFS or
10127something similar connecting the two systems, you must arrange some
10128other way---perhaps floppy-disk transfer---of getting the 29K program
10129from the Unix system to the PC; @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} download it over the
10130serial line.
10131
10132@node gdb-EB29K
10133@subsubsection EB29K cross-debugging
10134
10135Finally, @code{cd} to the directory containing an image of your 29K
10136program on the Unix system, and start @value{GDBN}---specifying as argument the
10137name of your 29K program:
10138
10139@example
10140cd /usr/joe/work29k
10141@value{GDBP} myfoo
10142@end example
10143
10144@need 500
10145Now you can use the @code{target} command:
10146
10147@example
10148target amd-eb /dev/ttya 9600 MYFOO
10149@c FIXME: test above 'target amd-eb' as spelled, with caps! caps are meant to
10150@c emphasize that this is the name as seen by DOS (since I think DOS is
10151@c single-minded about case of letters). ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
10152@end example
10153
10154@noindent
10155In this example, we've assumed your program is in a file called
10156@file{myfoo}. Note that the filename given as the last argument to
10157@code{target amd-eb} should be the name of the program as it appears to DOS.
10158In our example this is simply @code{MYFOO}, but in general it can include
10159a DOS path, and depending on your transfer mechanism may not resemble
10160the name on the Unix side.
10161
10162At this point, you can set any breakpoints you wish; when you are ready
10163to see your program run on the 29K board, use the @value{GDBN} command
10164@code{run}.
10165
10166To stop debugging the remote program, use the @value{GDBN} @code{detach}
10167command.
10168
10169To return control of the PC to its console, use @code{tip} or @code{cu}
10170once again, after your @value{GDBN} session has concluded, to attach to
10171@code{EBMON}. You can then type the command @code{q} to shut down
10172@code{EBMON}, returning control to the DOS command-line interpreter.
d4f3574e 10173Type @kbd{CTTY con} to return command input to the main DOS console,
104c1213
JM
10174and type @kbd{~.} to leave @code{tip} or @code{cu}.
10175
10176@node Remote Log
10177@subsubsection Remote log
10178@kindex eb.log
10179@cindex log file for EB29K
10180
10181The @code{target amd-eb} command creates a file @file{eb.log} in the
10182current working directory, to help debug problems with the connection.
10183@file{eb.log} records all the output from @code{EBMON}, including echoes
10184of the commands sent to it. Running @samp{tail -f} on this file in
10185another window often helps to understand trouble with @code{EBMON}, or
10186unexpected events on the PC side of the connection.
10187
10188@node ARM
10189@subsection ARM
10190
10191@table @code
10192
10193@kindex target rdi
10194@item target rdi @var{dev}
10195ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
10196use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
10197monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
10198
10199@kindex target rdp
10200@item target rdp @var{dev}
10201ARM Demon monitor.
10202
10203@end table
10204
10205@node H8/300
10206@subsection Hitachi H8/300
10207
10208@table @code
10209
d4f3574e 10210@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
10211@item target hms @var{dev}
10212A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
10213Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
10214line and the communications speed used.
10215
d4f3574e 10216@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
10217@item target e7000 @var{dev}
10218E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
10219
d4f3574e
SS
10220@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
10221@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
10222@item target sh3 @var{dev}
10223@item target sh3e @var{dev}
10224Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
10225
10226@end table
10227
10228@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
10229@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
10230@cindex download to Hitachi SH
10231@cindex Hitachi SH download
10232When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
10233board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
10234board and also opens it as the current executable target for
10235@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
10236
10237@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
10238Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
10239
10240@enumerate
10241@item
10242that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
10243for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
10244emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
2df3850c 10245the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
104c1213
JM
10246H8/300, or H8/500.)
10247
10248@item
10249what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
10250serial device available on your host is the default).
10251
10252@item
10253what speed to use over the serial device.
10254@end enumerate
10255
10256@menu
10257* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
10258* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
10259* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
10260@end menu
10261
10262@node Hitachi Boards
10263@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
10264
10265@c only for Unix hosts
10266@kindex device
10267@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
10268Use the special @code{@value{GDBP}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
10269need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
10270first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
10271hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
10272
10273@kindex speed
10274@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
10275@code{@value{GDBP}} has another special command to set the communications
10276speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
2df3850c 10277hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
d4f3574e
SS
10278the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
10279@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
104c1213
JM
10280
10281The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
10282use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
10283use a DOS host,
10284@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
10285called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
10286through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
10287to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
10288
10289The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
10290program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
10291sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
10292the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
10293
10294First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
10295board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
10296port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
10297When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
d4f3574e 10298debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
104c1213
JM
10299for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
10300@code{COM2}.
10301
10302@example
10303C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
10304C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
10305
10306Resident portion of MODE loaded
10307
10308COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
10309
10310@end example
10311
10312@quotation
10313@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
10314@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
10315disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
10316your development board.
10317@end quotation
10318
d4f3574e 10319@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
104c1213
JM
10320Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
10321connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
10322the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBP}} prompts
10323you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
10324commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
10325cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
10326download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
10327the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
10328(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
10329executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
10330@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
10331itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
10332
10333@smallexample
10334(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
2df3850c 10335@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
104c1213
JM
10336 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
10337 the conditions.
2df3850c 10338There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
104c1213 10339for details.
2df3850c
JM
10340@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
10341(@value{GDBP}) target hms
104c1213 10342Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
2df3850c 10343(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
104c1213
JM
10344.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
10345.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
10346.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
10347@end smallexample
10348
10349At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
10350you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
10351sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
10352@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
10353resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
10354@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
10355
10356Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
10357available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
10358you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
10359
10360Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
10361@itemize @bullet
10362@item
10363to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
10364no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
10365
10366@item
10367to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
10368normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
10369to detect program completion.
10370@end itemize
10371
10372In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
10373development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
10374
10375@node Hitachi ICE
10376@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
10377
d4f3574e 10378@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
104c1213
JM
10379You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
10380Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
10381e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
10382
10383@table @code
10384@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
10385Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
10386@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
10387@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
10388(for example, @samp{9600}).
10389
10390@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
10391If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
10392specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
10393@end table
10394
10395@node Hitachi Special
10396@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
10397
10398Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
10399
10400@table @code
10401
10402@kindex set machine
10403@kindex show machine
10404@item set machine h8300
10405@itemx set machine h8300h
10406Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
10407architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
10408to check which variant is currently in effect.
10409
10410@end table
10411
10412@node H8/500
10413@subsection H8/500
10414
10415@table @code
10416
10417@kindex set memory @var{mod}
10418@cindex memory models, H8/500
10419@item set memory @var{mod}
10420@itemx show memory
10421Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
10422@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
10423memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
10424@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
10425
10426@end table
10427
10428@node i960
10429@subsection Intel i960
10430
10431@table @code
10432
10433@kindex target mon960
10434@item target mon960 @var{dev}
10435MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
10436
10437@item target nindy @var{devicename}
10438An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
10439the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
10440@file{/dev/ttya}.
10441
10442@end table
10443
10444@cindex Nindy
10445@cindex i960
10446@dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
10447@value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
10448tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
10449
10450@itemize @bullet
10451@item
10452Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
10453Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
10454
10455@item
10456By responding to a prompt on startup;
10457
10458@item
10459By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
10460session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
10461
10462@kindex target nindy
10463@item target nindy @var{devicename}
10464An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
10465the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
10466@file{/dev/ttya}.
10467
10468@end itemize
10469
10470@cindex download to Nindy-960
10471With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
10472downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
10473@value{GDBN}.
10474
10475@menu
10476* Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
10477* Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
10478* Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
10479@end menu
10480
10481@node Nindy Startup
10482@subsubsection Startup with Nindy
10483
10484If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
10485options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
10486reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
10487
10488@example
10489Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
10490@end example
10491
10492@noindent
10493Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
10494identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
10495simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
10496with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
10497use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
10498
10499@node Nindy Options
10500@subsubsection Options for Nindy
10501
10502These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
10503Nindy-960 board attached:
10504
10505@table @code
10506@item -r @var{port}
10507Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
10508to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
10509configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
10510@var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
10511device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
10512suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
10513
10514@item -O
10515(An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
10516the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
10517This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
10518target architecture.
10519
10520@quotation
10521@emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
10522connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
10523fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
10524attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
10525this process with an interrupt.
10526@end quotation
10527
10528@item -brk
10529Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
10530system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
10531
10532@quotation
10533@emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
10534requires; it only works with a few boards.
10535@end quotation
10536@end table
10537
10538The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
10539port.
10540
10541@c @group
10542@node Nindy Reset
10543@subsubsection Nindy reset command
10544
10545@table @code
10546@item reset
10547@kindex reset
10548For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
10549system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
10550circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
10551a break is detected.
10552@end table
10553@c @end group
10554
10555@node M32R/D
10556@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
10557
10558@table @code
10559
10560@kindex target m32r
10561@item target m32r @var{dev}
10562Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
10563
10564@end table
10565
10566@node M68K
10567@subsection M68k
10568
10569The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
10570target command for the following ROM monitors.
10571
10572@table @code
10573
10574@kindex target abug
10575@item target abug @var{dev}
10576ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
10577
10578@kindex target cpu32bug
10579@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
10580CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
10581
10582@kindex target dbug
10583@item target dbug @var{dev}
10584dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
10585
10586@kindex target est
10587@item target est @var{dev}
10588EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
10589
10590@kindex target rom68k
10591@item target rom68k @var{dev}
10592ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
10593
10594@end table
10595
10596If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
10597instead have only a single special target command:
10598
10599@table @code
10600
10601@kindex target es1800
10602@item target es1800 @var{dev}
10603ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
10604
10605@end table
10606
10607[context?]
10608
10609@table @code
10610
10611@kindex target rombug
10612@item target rombug @var{dev}
10613ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
10614
10615@end table
10616
10617@node M88K
10618@subsection M88K
10619
10620@table @code
10621
10622@kindex target bug
10623@item target bug @var{dev}
10624BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
10625
10626@end table
10627
10628@node MIPS Embedded
10629@subsection MIPS Embedded
10630
10631@cindex MIPS boards
10632@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
10633MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
10634you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
10635
10636@need 1000
10637Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
10638
10639@table @code
10640@item target mips @var{port}
10641@kindex target mips @var{port}
10642To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
10643name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
10644command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
10645the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
10646been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
10647download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
10648
10649For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
10650port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
10651debugger:
10652
10653@example
10654host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
2df3850c
JM
10655@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
10656(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
10657(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
10658(@value{GDBP}) run
104c1213
JM
10659@end example
10660
10661@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
10662On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
10663connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
10664concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
10665@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
10666
10667@item target pmon @var{port}
10668@kindex target pmon @var{port}
10669PMON ROM monitor.
10670
10671@item target ddb @var{port}
10672@kindex target ddb @var{port}
10673NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
10674
10675@item target lsi @var{port}
10676@kindex target lsi @var{port}
10677LSI variant of PMON.
10678
10679@kindex target r3900
10680@item target r3900 @var{dev}
10681Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
10682
10683@kindex target array
10684@item target array @var{dev}
10685Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
10686
10687@end table
10688
10689
10690@noindent
10691@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
10692
10693@table @code
10694@item set processor @var{args}
10695@itemx show processor
10696@kindex set processor @var{args}
10697@kindex show processor
10698Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
10699processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
10700For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
10701to use the CPO registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
10702Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
10703is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
10704@value{GDBN} is using.
10705
10706@item set mipsfpu double
10707@itemx set mipsfpu single
10708@itemx set mipsfpu none
10709@itemx show mipsfpu
10710@kindex set mipsfpu
10711@kindex show mipsfpu
10712@cindex MIPS remote floating point
10713@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
10714If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
10715coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
10716need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBINIT}
10717file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
10718functions which return floating point values. It also allows
10719@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
10720functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
10721with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
10722processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
10723double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
10724@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
10725
10726In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
10727floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
10728and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
10729
10730As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
10731@samp{show mipsfpu}.
10732
10733@item set remotedebug @var{n}
10734@itemx show remotedebug
d4f3574e
SS
10735@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
10736@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
104c1213
JM
10737@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
10738@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
10739@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
10740@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
10741You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
10742by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
10743@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
10744to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
10745at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
10746
10747@item set timeout @var{seconds}
10748@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
10749@itemx show timeout
10750@itemx show retransmit-timeout
10751@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
10752@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
10753@kindex set timeout
10754@kindex show timeout
10755@kindex set retransmit-timeout
10756@kindex show retransmit-timeout
10757You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
10758remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
10759default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
10760waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
10761retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
10762You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
10763retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
10764@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
10765
10766The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
10767is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
10768forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
10769to run before stopping.
10770@end table
10771
10772@node PowerPC
10773@subsection PowerPC
10774
10775@table @code
10776
10777@kindex target dink32
10778@item target dink32 @var{dev}
10779DINK32 ROM monitor.
10780
10781@kindex target ppcbug
10782@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
10783@kindex target ppcbug1
10784@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
10785PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
10786
10787@kindex target sds
10788@item target sds @var{dev}
10789SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
10790
10791@end table
10792
10793@node PA
10794@subsection HP PA Embedded
10795
10796@table @code
10797
10798@kindex target op50n
10799@item target op50n @var{dev}
10800OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
10801
10802@kindex target w89k
10803@item target w89k @var{dev}
10804W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
10805
10806@end table
10807
10808@node SH
10809@subsection Hitachi SH
10810
10811@table @code
10812
d4f3574e 10813@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
10814@item target hms @var{dev}
10815A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
10816commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
10817the communications speed used.
10818
d4f3574e 10819@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
10820@item target e7000 @var{dev}
10821E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
10822
d4f3574e
SS
10823@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
10824@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
104c1213
JM
10825@item target sh3 @var{dev}
10826@item target sh3e @var{dev}
10827Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
10828
10829@end table
10830
10831@node Sparclet
10832@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
10833
10834@cindex Sparclet
10835
10836@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
10837Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
10838@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
10839both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
d4f3574e 10840@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213
JM
10841
10842@table @code
10843@item timeout @var{args}
10844@kindex remotetimeout
d4f3574e 10845@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
104c1213
JM
10846This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
10847seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
10848@end table
10849
10850@kindex Compiling
d4f3574e
SS
10851When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
10852information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
10853load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
10854@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213
JM
10855
10856@example
10857sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
10858@end example
10859
d4f3574e 10860You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213
JM
10861
10862@example
10863sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
10864@end example
10865
10866@kindex Running
10867Once you have set
10868your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
d4f3574e 10869run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
104c1213
JM
10870(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
10871
10872@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
10873
10874@example
10875(gdbslet)
10876@end example
10877
10878@menu
10879* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
10880* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
10881* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
10882* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
10883@end menu
10884
10885@node Sparclet File
10886@subsubsection Setting file to debug
10887
10888The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
10889
10890@example
10891(gdbslet) file prog
10892@end example
10893
10894@need 1000
10895@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
10896@value{GDBN} locates
10897the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
10898path.
10899If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
10900files will be searched as well.
10901@value{GDBN} locates
10902the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
10903path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
10904If it fails
10905to find a file, it displays a message such as:
10906
10907@example
10908prog: No such file or directory.
10909@end example
10910
10911When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
10912the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
10913@code{target} command again.
10914
10915@node Sparclet Connection
10916@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
10917
10918The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
10919To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
10920
10921@example
10922(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
10923Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
10924main () at ../prog.c:3
10925@end example
10926
10927@need 750
10928@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
10929
d4f3574e 10930@example
104c1213 10931Connected to ttya.
d4f3574e 10932@end example
104c1213
JM
10933
10934@node Sparclet Download
10935@subsubsection Sparclet download
10936
10937@cindex download to Sparclet
10938Once connected to the Sparclet target,
10939you can use the @value{GDBN}
10940@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
10941The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
10942command.
10943Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
d4f3574e 10944address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
104c1213
JM
10945offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
10946of each of the file's sections.
10947For instance, if the program
10948@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
10949and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
10950
10951@example
10952(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
10953Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
10954@end example
10955
10956If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
10957to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
10958to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
10959
10960@node Sparclet Execution
10961@subsubsection Running and debugging
10962
10963@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
10964You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
10965commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
10966manual for the list of commands.
10967
10968@example
10969(gdbslet) b main
10970Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
10971(gdbslet) run
10972Starting program: prog
10973Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
109743 char *symarg = 0;
10975(gdbslet) step
109764 char *execarg = "hello!";
10977(gdbslet)
10978@end example
10979
10980@node Sparclite
10981@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
10982
10983@table @code
10984
10985@kindex target sparclite
10986@item target sparclite @var{dev}
10987Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
10988You must use an additional command to debug the program.
10989For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
10990remote protocol.
10991
10992@end table
10993
10994@node ST2000
10995@subsection Tandem ST2000
10996
2df3850c 10997@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
104c1213
JM
10998STDBUG protocol.
10999
11000To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
11001manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
11002
11003@example
11004target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
11005@end example
11006
11007@noindent
11008to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
11009the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
11010ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
11011connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
11012concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
11013
11014The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
11015this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
11016would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
11017(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
11018available on your host computer.
11019@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
11020@c basically hearsay.
11021
11022@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
11023These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
11024environment:
11025
11026@table @code
11027@item st2000 @var{command}
11028@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
11029@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
11030@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
11031Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
11032manual for available commands.
11033
11034@item connect
11035@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
11036Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
11037you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
11038sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
11039@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
11040@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
11041@end table
11042
11043@node Z8000
11044@subsection Zilog Z8000
11045
11046@cindex Z8000
11047@cindex simulator, Z8000
11048@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
11049
11050When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
11051a Z8000 simulator.
11052
11053For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
11054unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
11055segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
11056appropriate by inspecting the object code.
11057
11058@table @code
11059@item target sim @var{args}
11060@kindex sim
d4f3574e 11061@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
104c1213
JM
11062Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
11063options, specify them via @var{args}.
11064@end table
11065
11066@noindent
11067After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
11068CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
11069@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
11070to run your program, and so on.
11071
d4f3574e
SS
11072As well as making available all the usual machine registers
11073(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
11074additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
11075
11076@table @code
11077
11078@item cycles
11079Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
11080
11081@item insts
11082Counts instructions run in the simulator.
11083
11084@item time
11085Execution time in 60ths of a second.
11086
11087@end table
11088
11089You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
11090conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
11091conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
11092simulated clock ticks.
11093
11094@node Architectures
11095@section Architectures
11096
11097This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
2df3850c 11098all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213
JM
11099
11100@menu
11101* A29K::
11102* Alpha::
11103* MIPS::
11104@end menu
11105
11106@node A29K
11107@subsection A29K
11108
11109@table @code
11110
11111@kindex set rstack_high_address
11112@cindex AMD 29K register stack
11113@cindex register stack, AMD29K
11114@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
11115On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
d4f3574e 11116@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
104c1213
JM
11117extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
11118stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
11119memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
11120this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
11121the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
11122address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
11123hexadecimal.
11124
11125@kindex show rstack_high_address
11126@item show rstack_high_address
11127Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
11128processors.
11129
11130@end table
11131
11132@node Alpha
11133@subsection Alpha
11134
11135See the following section.
11136
11137@node MIPS
11138@subsection MIPS
11139
11140@cindex stack on Alpha
11141@cindex stack on MIPS
11142@cindex Alpha stack
11143@cindex MIPS stack
11144Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
11145sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
11146find the beginning of a function.
11147
11148@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
11149To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
11150@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
11151you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
11152commands:
11153
11154@table @code
11155@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha,MIPS)
11156@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
11157Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
11158search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
11159default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
11160larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
11161and therefore the longer it takes to run.
11162
11163@item show heuristic-fence-post
11164Display the current limit.
11165@end table
11166
11167@noindent
11168These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
11169for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
11170
11171
c906108c
SS
11172@node Controlling GDB
11173@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
11174
53a5351d
JM
11175You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
11176@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
d4f3574e 11177data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
53a5351d 11178described here.
c906108c
SS
11179
11180@menu
11181* Prompt:: Prompt
11182* Editing:: Command editing
11183* History:: Command history
11184* Screen Size:: Screen size
11185* Numbers:: Numbers
11186* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
11187@end menu
11188
53a5351d 11189@node Prompt
c906108c
SS
11190@section Prompt
11191
11192@cindex prompt
11193
11194@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
11195called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
11196can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
11197instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
11198the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
11199which one you are talking to.
11200
d4f3574e 11201@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
c906108c
SS
11202prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
11203or a prompt that does not.
11204
11205@table @code
11206@kindex set prompt
11207@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
11208Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
11209
11210@kindex show prompt
11211@item show prompt
11212Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
11213@end table
11214
53a5351d 11215@node Editing
c906108c
SS
11216@section Command editing
11217@cindex readline
11218@cindex command line editing
11219
11220@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
11221@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
11222command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
11223or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
11224substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
11225debugging sessions.
11226
11227You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
11228command @code{set}.
11229
11230@table @code
11231@kindex set editing
11232@cindex editing
11233@item set editing
11234@itemx set editing on
11235Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
11236
11237@item set editing off
11238Disable command line editing.
11239
11240@kindex show editing
11241@item show editing
11242Show whether command line editing is enabled.
11243@end table
11244
53a5351d 11245@node History
c906108c
SS
11246@section Command history
11247
11248@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
11249debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
11250happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
11251history facility.
11252
11253@table @code
11254@cindex history substitution
11255@cindex history file
11256@kindex set history filename
11257@kindex GDBHISTFILE
11258@item set history filename @var{fname}
11259Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
11260This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
11261list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
11262exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
11263the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
11264to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
d4f3574e
SS
11265@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
11266is not set.
c906108c
SS
11267
11268@cindex history save
11269@kindex set history save
11270@item set history save
11271@itemx set history save on
11272Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
11273@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
11274
11275@item set history save off
11276Stop recording command history in a file.
11277
11278@cindex history size
11279@kindex set history size
11280@item set history size @var{size}
11281Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
11282This defaults to the value of the environment variable
11283@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
11284@end table
11285
11286@cindex history expansion
11287History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
11288@ifset have-readline-appendices
11289@xref{Event Designators}.
11290@end ifset
11291
11292Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
11293is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
11294@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
11295follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
11296a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
11297history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
11298@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
11299
11300The commands to control history expansion are:
11301
11302@table @code
11303@kindex set history expansion
11304@item set history expansion on
11305@itemx set history expansion
11306Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
11307
11308@item set history expansion off
11309Disable history expansion.
11310
11311The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
11312editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
11313or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
11314@ifset have-readline-appendices
11315@xref{Command Line Editing}.
11316@end ifset
11317
11318@c @group
11319@kindex show history
11320@item show history
11321@itemx show history filename
11322@itemx show history save
11323@itemx show history size
11324@itemx show history expansion
11325These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
11326@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
11327@c @end group
11328@end table
11329
11330@table @code
11331@kindex show commands
11332@item show commands
11333Display the last ten commands in the command history.
11334
11335@item show commands @var{n}
11336Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
11337
11338@item show commands +
11339Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
11340@end table
11341
53a5351d 11342@node Screen Size
c906108c
SS
11343@section Screen size
11344@cindex size of screen
11345@cindex pauses in output
11346
11347Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
11348information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
11349@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
11350output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
11351to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
11352determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
11353printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
11354rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
11355
d4f3574e
SS
11356Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
11357driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
c906108c 11358together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
d4f3574e 11359@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
c906108c
SS
11360you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
11361width} commands:
11362
11363@table @code
11364@kindex set height
11365@kindex set width
11366@kindex show width
11367@kindex show height
11368@item set height @var{lpp}
11369@itemx show height
11370@itemx set width @var{cpl}
11371@itemx show width
11372These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
11373a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
11374commands display the current settings.
11375
11376If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
11377output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
11378file or to an editor buffer.
11379
11380Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
11381from wrapping its output.
11382@end table
11383
53a5351d 11384@node Numbers
c906108c
SS
11385@section Numbers
11386@cindex number representation
11387@cindex entering numbers
11388
2df3850c
JM
11389You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
11390@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
11391@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
11392begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
11393default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
11394numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
11395change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
11396radix} command.
c906108c
SS
11397
11398@table @code
11399@kindex set input-radix
11400@item set input-radix @var{base}
11401Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
11402for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
11403specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
11404example, any of
11405
11406@smallexample
11407set radix 012
11408set radix 10.
11409set radix 0xa
11410@end smallexample
11411
11412@noindent
11413sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
11414leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
11415
11416@kindex set output-radix
11417@item set output-radix @var{base}
11418Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
11419for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
11420specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
11421
11422@kindex show input-radix
11423@item show input-radix
11424Display the current default base for numeric input.
11425
11426@kindex show output-radix
11427@item show output-radix
11428Display the current default base for numeric display.
11429@end table
11430
53a5351d 11431@node Messages/Warnings
c906108c
SS
11432@section Optional warnings and messages
11433
2df3850c
JM
11434By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
11435running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
11436command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
11437internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
c906108c
SS
11438
11439Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
11440which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
11441see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
11442
11443@table @code
11444@kindex set verbose
11445@item set verbose on
11446Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
11447
11448@item set verbose off
11449Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
11450
11451@kindex show verbose
11452@item show verbose
11453Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
11454@end table
11455
2df3850c
JM
11456By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
11457object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
11458find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
11459symbol files}).
c906108c
SS
11460
11461@table @code
2df3850c 11462
c906108c
SS
11463@kindex set complaints
11464@item set complaints @var{limit}
2df3850c
JM
11465Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
11466unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
11467@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
11468to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
c906108c
SS
11469
11470@kindex show complaints
11471@item show complaints
11472Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
2df3850c 11473
c906108c
SS
11474@end table
11475
11476By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
11477lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
11478you try to run a program which is already running:
11479
11480@example
11481(@value{GDBP}) run
11482The program being debugged has been started already.
11483Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
11484@end example
11485
11486If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
11487commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
11488
11489@table @code
2df3850c 11490
c906108c
SS
11491@kindex set confirm
11492@cindex flinching
11493@cindex confirmation
11494@cindex stupid questions
11495@item set confirm off
11496Disables confirmation requests.
11497
11498@item set confirm on
11499Enables confirmation requests (the default).
11500
11501@kindex show confirm
11502@item show confirm
11503Displays state of confirmation requests.
2df3850c 11504
c906108c
SS
11505@end table
11506
53a5351d 11507@node Sequences
c906108c
SS
11508@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
11509
11510Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
2df3850c
JM
11511command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
11512commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
11513files.
c906108c
SS
11514
11515@menu
11516* Define:: User-defined commands
11517* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
11518* Command Files:: Command files
11519* Output:: Commands for controlled output
11520@end menu
11521
53a5351d 11522@node Define
c906108c
SS
11523@section User-defined commands
11524
11525@cindex user-defined command
2df3850c
JM
11526A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
11527which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
11528@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
11529separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
11530via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
c906108c
SS
11531
11532@smallexample
11533define adder
11534 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
11535@end smallexample
11536
d4f3574e
SS
11537@noindent
11538To execute the command use:
c906108c
SS
11539
11540@smallexample
11541adder 1 2 3
11542@end smallexample
11543
d4f3574e
SS
11544@noindent
11545This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
c906108c
SS
11546its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
11547reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
11548functions calls.
11549
11550@table @code
2df3850c 11551
c906108c
SS
11552@kindex define
11553@item define @var{commandname}
11554Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
11555by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
11556
11557The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
11558which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
11559commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
11560
11561@kindex if
11562@kindex else
11563@item if
11564Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
11565It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
11566only if the expression is true (nonzero).
11567There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
11568by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
11569was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
11570
11571@kindex while
11572@item while
11573The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
11574which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
11575execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
11576The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
11577evaluates to true.
11578
11579@kindex document
11580@item document @var{commandname}
11581Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
11582accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
11583defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
11584reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
11585After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
11586@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
11587
11588You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
11589documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
11590does not change the documentation.
11591
11592@kindex help user-defined
11593@item help user-defined
11594List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
11595(if any) for each.
11596
11597@kindex show user
11598@item show user
11599@itemx show user @var{commandname}
2df3850c
JM
11600Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
11601not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
c906108c 11602definitions for all user-defined commands.
2df3850c 11603
c906108c
SS
11604@end table
11605
11606When user-defined commands are executed, the
11607commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
11608stops execution of the user-defined command.
11609
11610If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
11611without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
11612commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
11613messages when used in a user-defined command.
11614
53a5351d 11615@node Hooks
c906108c 11616@section User-defined command hooks
d4f3574e
SS
11617@cindex command hooks
11618@cindex hooks, for commands
c906108c
SS
11619
11620You may define @emph{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
11621command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
11622command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
11623before that command.
11624
d4f3574e 11625@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
c906108c
SS
11626In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
11627(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
11628execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
11629displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
11630
c906108c
SS
11631For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
11632single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
11633you could define:
11634
11635@example
11636define hook-stop
11637handle SIGALRM nopass
11638end
11639
11640define hook-run
11641handle SIGALRM pass
11642end
11643
11644define hook-continue
11645handle SIGLARM pass
11646end
11647@end example
c906108c
SS
11648
11649You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
11650not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
11651name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
11652@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
11653@c or not?
11654If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
11655@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
11656(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
11657
11658If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
11659get a warning from the @code{define} command.
11660
53a5351d 11661@node Command Files
c906108c
SS
11662@section Command files
11663
11664@cindex command files
11665A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
11666commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
11667An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
11668the last command, as it would from the terminal.
11669
11670@cindex init file
11671@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
d4f3574e 11672@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
c906108c
SS
11673When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
11674@dfn{init files}. These are files named @file{.gdbinit} on Unix, or
11675@file{gdb.ini} on DOS/Windows. @value{GDBN} reads the init file (if
d4f3574e 11676any) in your home directory@footnote{On DOS/Windows systems, the home
2df3850c
JM
11677directory is the one pointed to by the @code{HOME} environment
11678variable.}, then processes command line options and operands, and then
11679reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory. This is
11680so the init file in your home directory can set options (such as
11681@code{set complaints}) which affect the processing of the command line
11682options and operands. The init files are not executed if you use the
11683@samp{-nx} option; @pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}.
c906108c 11684
c906108c
SS
11685@cindex init file name
11686On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
11687different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
11688form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
11689different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
11690environments with special init file names:
11691
11692@kindex .vxgdbinit
11693@itemize @bullet
11694@item
11695VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @samp{.vxgdbinit}
11696
11697@kindex .os68gdbinit
11698@item
11699OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @samp{.os68gdbinit}
11700
11701@kindex .esgdbinit
11702@item
11703ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @samp{.esgdbinit}
11704@end itemize
c906108c
SS
11705
11706You can also request the execution of a command file with the
11707@code{source} command:
11708
11709@table @code
11710@kindex source
11711@item source @var{filename}
11712Execute the command file @var{filename}.
11713@end table
11714
11715The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
11716printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates execution
11717of the command file.
11718
11719Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
11720without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
11721normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
11722when called from command files.
11723
53a5351d 11724@node Output
c906108c
SS
11725@section Commands for controlled output
11726
11727During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
11728@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
11729explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
11730describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
11731want.
11732
11733@table @code
11734@kindex echo
11735@item echo @var{text}
11736@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
11737@c because it is not in ANSI.
11738Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
11739@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
11740newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
11741In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
11742by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
11743string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
11744trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
11745To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
11746@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
11747
11748A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
11749the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
11750
11751@example
11752echo This is some text\n\
11753which is continued\n\
11754onto several lines.\n
11755@end example
11756
11757produces the same output as
11758
11759@example
11760echo This is some text\n
11761echo which is continued\n
11762echo onto several lines.\n
11763@end example
11764
11765@kindex output
11766@item output @var{expression}
11767Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
11768newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
11769value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
11770on expressions.
11771
11772@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
11773Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
11774the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
11775formats}, for more information.
11776
11777@kindex printf
11778@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
11779Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
11780@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
11781either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
11782@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
11783subroutine
d4f3574e
SS
11784@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
11785@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
11786@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
11787@c supported.
c906108c
SS
11788
11789@example
11790printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
11791@end example
11792
11793For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
11794
11795@smallexample
11796printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
11797@end smallexample
11798
11799The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
11800string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
11801letter.
11802@end table
11803
53a5351d 11804@node Emacs
c906108c
SS
11805@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
11806
11807@cindex Emacs
11808@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
11809A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
11810edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
11811@value{GDBN}.
11812
11813To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
11814executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
11815@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
11816created Emacs buffer.
53a5351d 11817@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c
SS
11818
11819Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
11820things:
11821
11822@itemize @bullet
11823@item
11824All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
11825@end itemize
11826
11827This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
11828and output done by the program you are debugging.
11829
11830This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
11831commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
11832in this way.
11833
11834All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
11835with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
11836way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
11837stop.
11838
11839@itemize @bullet
11840@item
11841@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
11842@end itemize
11843
11844Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
11845source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
11846left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
11847source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
11848and the source.
11849
11850Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
11851usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
11852
11853@quotation
11854@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
11855current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
11856the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
11857appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
11858environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
11859session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
11860back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
11861avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
11862your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
11863@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
11864
11865A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
11866switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
11867@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
11868@end quotation
11869
11870By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
11871you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
11872several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
11873Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
11874
11875@example
11876(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
11877@end example
11878
11879@noindent
d4f3574e 11880(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
c906108c
SS
11881in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
11882``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
11883
11884In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
11885addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
11886
11887@table @kbd
11888@item C-h m
11889Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
11890
11891@item M-s
11892Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
11893update the display window to show the current file and location.
11894
11895@item M-n
11896Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
11897calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
11898to show the current file and location.
11899
11900@item M-i
11901Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
11902display window accordingly.
11903
11904@item M-x gdb-nexti
11905Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
11906display window accordingly.
11907
11908@item C-c C-f
11909Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
11910@code{finish} command.
11911
11912@item M-c
11913Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
11914command.
11915
11916@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
11917
11918@item M-u
11919Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
11920(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
11921like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
11922
11923@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
11924
11925@item M-d
11926Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
11927@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
11928
11929@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
11930
11931@item C-x &
11932Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
11933of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
11934around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
11935then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
11936argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
11937
11938You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
11939@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
11940otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
11941inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
11942wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
11943list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
11944formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
11945is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
11946@end table
11947
11948In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
11949tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
11950
11951If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
11952it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
11953request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
11954the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
11955frame.
11956
11957The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
11958which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
11959the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
11960communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
11961delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
11962to correspond properly with the code.
11963
11964@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
11965@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
11966@ignore
11967@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
11968@kindex Epoch
11969@kindex inspect
11970
11971Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
11972called the @code{epoch}
11973environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
11974@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
11975each value is printed in its own window.
11976@end ignore
c906108c 11977
d700128c
EZ
11978@include annotate.texi
11979
c906108c 11980@node GDB Bugs
c906108c
SS
11981@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
11982@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
11983@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
11984
11985Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
11986
11987Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
11988may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
11989the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
11990reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
11991
11992In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
11993information that enables us to fix the bug.
11994
11995@menu
11996* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
11997* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
11998@end menu
11999
53a5351d 12000@node Bug Criteria
c906108c
SS
12001@section Have you found a bug?
12002@cindex bug criteria
12003
12004If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
12005
12006@itemize @bullet
12007@cindex fatal signal
12008@cindex debugger crash
12009@cindex crash of debugger
12010@item
12011If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
12012@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
12013
12014@cindex error on valid input
12015@item
12016If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
12017bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
12018somewhere in the connection to the target.)
12019
12020@cindex invalid input
12021@item
12022If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
12023that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
12024``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
12025for traditional practice''.
12026
12027@item
12028If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
12029for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
12030@end itemize
12031
53a5351d 12032@node Bug Reporting
c906108c
SS
12033@section How to report bugs
12034@cindex bug reports
12035@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
12036
c906108c
SS
12037A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
12038If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
12039contact that organization first.
12040
12041You can find contact information for many support companies and
12042individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
12043distribution.
12044@c should add a web page ref...
12045
12046In any event, we also recommend that you send bug reports for
12047@value{GDBN} to this addresses:
12048
12049@example
d4f3574e 12050bug-gdb@@gnu.org
c906108c
SS
12051@end example
12052
12053@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
d4f3574e 12054@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
c906108c
SS
12055not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
12056@samp{bug-gdb}.
12057
12058The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
12059serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
12060the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
12061newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
12062problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
12063path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
12064we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
12065bug reports to the mailing list.
12066
12067As a last resort, send bug reports on paper to:
12068
12069@example
12070@sc{gnu} Debugger Bugs
12071Free Software Foundation Inc.
1207259 Temple Place - Suite 330
12073Boston, MA 02111-1307
12074USA
12075@end example
c906108c
SS
12076
12077The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
12078@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
12079fact or leave it out, state it!
12080
12081Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
12082problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
12083assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
12084Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
12085stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
12086name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
12087of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
12088the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
12089easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
12090
12091Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
12092bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
12093you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
12094self-contained.
12095
12096Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
12097bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
12098@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
12099bugs properly.
12100
12101To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
12102
12103@itemize @bullet
12104@item
12105The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
12106with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
12107version}.
12108
12109Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
12110the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
12111
12112@item
12113The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
12114version number.
12115
c906108c
SS
12116@item
12117What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
12118``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c906108c
SS
12119
12120@item
12121What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
12122debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
12123C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
12124information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
12125compilers.
12126
12127@item
12128The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
12129observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
12130you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
12131Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
12132
12133If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
12134and then we might not encounter the bug.
12135
12136@item
12137A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
12138reproduce the bug.
12139
12140@item
12141A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
12142incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
12143
12144Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
12145will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
12146not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
12147a chance to make a mistake.
12148
12149Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
12150say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
12151copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
12152the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
12153crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
12154ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
12155us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
12156to draw any conclusion from our observations.
12157
c906108c
SS
12158@item
12159If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
12160diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
12161it by context, not by line number.
12162
12163The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
12164sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
53a5351d 12165
c906108c
SS
12166@end itemize
12167
12168Here are some things that are not necessary:
12169
12170@itemize @bullet
12171@item
12172A description of the envelope of the bug.
12173
12174Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
12175which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
12176changes will not affect it.
12177
12178This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
12179will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
12180with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
12181We recommend that you save your time for something else.
12182
12183Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
12184of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
12185output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
12186less time, and so on.
12187
12188However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
12189report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
12190
12191@item
12192A patch for the bug.
12193
12194A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
12195the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
12196a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
12197to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
12198
12199Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
12200construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
12201through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
12202to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
12203
12204And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
12205patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
12206help us to understand.
12207
12208@item
12209A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
12210
12211Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
12212things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
12213@end itemize
12214
12215@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
12216@c and consists of the two following files:
12217@c rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 12218@c inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
12219@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
12220@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
12221@include rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 12222@include inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
12223
12224
c906108c 12225@node Formatting Documentation
c906108c
SS
12226@appendix Formatting Documentation
12227
12228@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
12229@cindex reference card
12230The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
12231for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
12232subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
12233@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
12234release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
12235you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
12236
12237The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
12238can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
12239
12240@example
12241make refcard.dvi
12242@end example
12243
12244The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
12245mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
12246that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
12247high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
12248your @sc{dvi} output program.
12249
12250@cindex documentation
12251
12252All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
12253distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
12254a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
12255on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
12256formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
12257and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
12258
12259@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
12260version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
12261file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
12262subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
12263necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
12264but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
12265Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
12266@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
12267
12268If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
12269Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
12270@code{makeinfo}.
12271
12272If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
12273@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
12274version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
12275
12276@example
12277cd gdb
12278make gdb.info
12279@end example
12280
12281If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
12282a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
12283Texinfo definitions file.
12284
12285@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
12286produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
12287document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
12288has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
12289command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
12290(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
12291require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
12292
12293@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
12294@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
12295written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
12296typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
12297and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
12298directory.
12299
12300If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
12301typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
12302subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
12303@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
12304
12305@example
12306make gdb.dvi
12307@end example
12308
12309Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c906108c 12310
53a5351d 12311@node Installing GDB
c906108c
SS
12312@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
12313@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
12314@cindex installation
12315
c906108c
SS
12316@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
12317of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
12318build the @code{gdb} program.
12319@iftex
12320@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
12321@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
12322look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
12323installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
12324@end iftex
12325
12326The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
12327@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
12328appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
12329
12330For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
12331@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
12332
12333@table @code
12334@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
12335script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
12336
12337@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
12338the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
12339
12340@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
12341source for the Binary File Descriptor library
12342
12343@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
12344@sc{gnu} include files
12345
12346@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
12347source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
12348
12349@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
12350source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
12351
12352@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
12353source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
12354
12355@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
12356source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
12357
12358@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
12359source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
12360@end table
12361
12362The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
12363from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
12364this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
12365
12366First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
12367if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
12368identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
12369argument.
12370
12371For example:
12372
12373@example
12374cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
12375./configure @var{host}
12376make
12377@end example
12378
12379@noindent
12380where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
12381@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
12382(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
12383correct value by examining your system.)
12384
12385Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
12386@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
12387libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
12388binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
12389
12390@need 750
12391@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
12392system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
12393shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
12394
12395@example
12396sh configure @var{host}
12397@end example
12398
12399If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
12400directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
12401@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
12402creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
12403you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
12404
12405You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
12406subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
12407configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
12408
12409For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
12410the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
12411
12412@example
12413@group
12414cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
12415../configure @var{host}
12416@end group
12417@end example
12418
12419You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
12420However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
12421the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
12422that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
12423let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
12424
12425@menu
12426* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
12427* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
12428* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
12429@end menu
12430
53a5351d 12431@node Separate Objdir
c906108c
SS
12432@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
12433
12434If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
12435you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
12436host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
12437allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
12438rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
12439handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
12440@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
12441program specified there.
12442
12443To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
12444with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
12445(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
12446itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
12447would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
12448the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
12449
12450For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
12451separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
12452
12453@example
12454@group
12455cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
12456mkdir ../gdb-sun4
12457cd ../gdb-sun4
12458../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
12459make
12460@end group
12461@end example
12462
12463When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
12464directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
12465(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
12466the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
12467directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
12468@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
12469
12470One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
12471directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
12472@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
12473programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
12474You specify a cross-debugging target by
12475giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
12476
12477When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
12478it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
12479called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
12480
12481The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
12482directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
12483directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
12484directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
12485will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
12486
12487When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
12488directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
12489if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
12490with each other.
12491
53a5351d 12492@node Config Names
c906108c
SS
12493@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
12494
12495The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
12496script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
12497aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
12498of information in the following pattern:
12499
12500@example
12501@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
12502@end example
12503
12504For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
12505or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
12506option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
12507
12508The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
12509any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
12510aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
12511@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
12512script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
12513abbreviations---for example:
12514
12515@smallexample
12516% sh config.sub i386-linux
12517i386-pc-linux-gnu
12518% sh config.sub alpha-linux
12519alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
12520% sh config.sub hp9k700
12521hppa1.1-hp-hpux
12522% sh config.sub sun4
12523sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
12524% sh config.sub sun3
12525m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
12526% sh config.sub i986v
12527Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
12528@end smallexample
12529
12530@noindent
12531@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
12532directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
12533
53a5351d 12534@node Configure Options
c906108c
SS
12535@section @code{configure} options
12536
12537Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
12538are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
12539several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
12540Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
12541
12542@example
12543configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
12544 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
12545 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
12546 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
12547 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
12548 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
12549 @var{host}
12550@end example
12551
12552@noindent
12553You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
12554@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
12555@samp{--}.
12556
12557@table @code
12558@item --help
12559Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
12560
12561@item --prefix=@var{dir}
12562Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
12563@file{@var{dir}}.
12564
12565@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
12566Configure the source to install programs under directory
12567@file{@var{dir}}.
12568
12569@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
12570@need 2000
12571@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
12572@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
12573@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
12574Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
12575@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
12576build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
12577directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
12578the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
12579directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
12580the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
12581@var{dirname}.
12582
12583@item --norecursion
12584Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
12585propagate configuration to subdirectories.
12586
12587@item --target=@var{target}
12588Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
12589@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
12590programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
12591
12592There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
12593
12594@item @var{host} @dots{}
12595Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
12596
12597There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
12598@end table
12599
12600There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
12601needed for special purposes only.
c906108c 12602
53a5351d 12603@node Index
c906108c
SS
12604@unnumbered Index
12605
12606@printindex cp
12607
12608@tex
12609% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
12610% meantime:
12611\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
12612\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
12613\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
12614\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
12615\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
12616\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
12617\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
12618\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
12619\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
12620\page\colophon
12621% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
12622@end tex
12623
12624@contents
12625@bye